blob: 108677abb8a4cbaef29a1748cb18855f42583e8b [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Chandler Carruthaa36b892015-12-30 03:40:23 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclContextInternals.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000024#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000025#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000027#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000028#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000029#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000031#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000032#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000033#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000034#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000035#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000036#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000039#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000040#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000041#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000042#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000043#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000044
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000045using namespace clang;
46
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000047unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
48unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000049unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
50unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000051unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
52unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000053unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
54unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000055unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
56unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000057unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
58unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
59
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000060enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000061 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000062};
63
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000064RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000065 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
66 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +000067
68#ifndef NDEBUG
69 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
70 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
71 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
72#endif
73
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000074 CommentsLoaded = true;
75 }
76
77 assert(D);
78
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000079 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
80 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000081 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000082
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000083 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
84 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
85 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000086 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000087 }
88
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000089 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
90 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
91 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000092 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000093 }
94
95 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
96 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000097 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000098 }
99
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000100 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
101 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
102 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
103 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
104 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000105 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000106 }
107
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000108 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
109 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000110 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000111 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000112 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
113 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
114 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
115 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000116 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000117 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000118 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
119 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000120 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000121
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000122 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
123 // documentation.
124 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
126 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000127 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000128
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000129 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000130
131 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
132 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000133 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000134
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000135 // Find declaration location.
136 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
137 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
138 // location".
139 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
140 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
141 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
142 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000143 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000144 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
145 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000146 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000147 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000148 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000149 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
150 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
151 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
152 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
153 // the "declaration location".
154 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
155 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
156 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
157 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
158 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
159 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
160 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
161 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
162 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
163 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
164 }
165 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000166 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000167
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000168 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
169 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000170 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000171 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000172
173 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000174 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
175 {
176 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
177 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
178 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000179 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
180 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
181 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000182 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
183 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
184 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
185 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
186 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
187 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
188 }
189
190 if (Found) {
191 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
192 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
193 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
194 } else {
195 // Slow path.
196 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
197 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
198 }
199 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000200
201 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
202 // file buffer.
203 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
204
205 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
206 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000207 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000208 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000209 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000210 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000211 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000212 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
213 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
214 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
215 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
216 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
217 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000218 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000219 }
220 }
221
222 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
223 // Let's look at the previous comment.
224 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000225 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000226 --Comment;
227
228 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000229 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000230 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000231
232 // Decompose the end of the comment.
233 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000234 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000235
236 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
237 // aren't related.
238 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000239 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000240
241 // Get the corresponding buffer.
242 bool Invalid = false;
243 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
244 &Invalid).data();
245 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000246 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000247
248 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
249 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
250 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
251
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000252 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
253 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000254 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000255 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000256
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000257 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000258}
259
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000260namespace {
261/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
262/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000263/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000264const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000265 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000266 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000267 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000268 return FTD;
269
270 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
271 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
272 return D;
273
274 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
275 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
276 return FTD;
277
278 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
279 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
280 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
281 return MemberDecl;
282
283 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000284 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000285 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
286 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
287 // template?
288 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
289 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
290 return MemberDecl;
291
292 return D;
293 }
294 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
295 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
296 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
297 return CTD;
298
299 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
300 // specialization?
301 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
302 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
303 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
304 return D;
305 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
306 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
307 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
308 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
310 static_cast<const Decl*>(
311 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
312 }
313
314 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
315 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
316 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
317 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
318
319 return D;
320 }
321 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
322 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
323 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
324 return MemberDecl;
325
326 return D;
327 }
328 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000329 return D;
330}
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +0000331} // anonymous namespace
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000332
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000333const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
334 const Decl *D,
335 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000336 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000337
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000338 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
339 {
340 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
341 RedeclComments.find(D);
342 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
343 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000344 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
345 if (OriginalDecl)
346 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000347 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000348 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000349 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000350 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000351
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000352 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000353 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
354 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000355 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000356 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000357 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000358 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
359 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
360 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
361 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000362 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000363 break;
364 }
365 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000366 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
367 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000368 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
369 if (RC) {
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000370 // Call order swapped to work around ICE in VS2015 RTM (Release Win32)
371 // https://connect.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/feedback/details/1741530
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000372 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000373 Raw.setRaw(RC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000374 } else
375 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000376 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
377 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000378 if (RC)
379 break;
380 }
381 }
382
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000383 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
384 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000385
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000386 if (OriginalDecl)
387 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
388
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000389 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
390 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
391 Raw.setRaw(RC);
392 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000393 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000394
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000395 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
396 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000397 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
398 R = Raw;
399 }
400
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000401 return RC;
402}
403
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000404static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
405 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
406 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
407 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
408 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
409 if (!ID)
410 return;
411 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000412 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000413 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000414 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000415 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
416 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
417 }
418 }
419}
420
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000421comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
422 const Decl *D) const {
423 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
424 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
425 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
426 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
427 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000428 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
429 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000430 comments::FullComment *CFC =
431 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
432 ThisDeclInfo);
433 return CFC;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000434}
435
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000436comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
437 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000438 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000439}
440
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000441comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
442 const Decl *D,
443 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000444 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000445 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000446 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000447
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000448 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
449 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
450 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000451
452 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000453 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000454 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000455 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000456 return CFC;
457 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000458 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000459 }
460
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000461 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000462
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000463 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000464 if (!RC) {
465 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000466 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000467 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000468 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
469 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
470 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
471 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000472 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000473 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
474 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000475 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
476 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
477 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000478 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000479 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000480 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000481 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000482 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000483 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
484 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
485 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000486 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000487 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000488 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
489 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
490 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
491 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
492 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
493 }
494 }
495 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
496 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
497 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
498 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
499 }
500 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
501 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000502 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000503 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000504 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
505 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000506 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000507 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000508 if (Ty.isNull())
509 continue;
510 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
511 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
512 continue;
513
514 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
515 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
516 }
517 }
518 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000519 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
520 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000521 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000522 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000523 if (Ty.isNull())
524 continue;
525 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
526 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
527 continue;
528 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
529 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
530 }
531 }
532 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000533 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000534 }
535
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000536 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
537 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
538 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
539 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000540 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000541 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000542
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000543 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000544 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
545 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000546}
547
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000548void
549ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
550 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
551 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
552 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000553 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000554
555 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
556 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
557 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
558 PEnd = Params->end();
559 P != PEnd; ++P) {
560 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
561 ID.AddInteger(0);
562 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
563 continue;
564 }
565
566 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
567 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000568 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000569 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000570 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
571 ID.AddBoolean(true);
572 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000573 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
574 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
575 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
576 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000577 } else
578 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000579 continue;
580 }
581
582 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
583 ID.AddInteger(2);
584 Profile(ID, TTP);
585 }
586}
587
588TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
589ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000590 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000591 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
592 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
593 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000594 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000595 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
596 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
597 if (Canonical)
598 return Canonical->getParam();
599
600 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
601 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000602 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000603 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
604 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
605 PEnd = Params->end();
606 P != PEnd; ++P) {
607 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
608 CanonParams.push_back(
609 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000610 SourceLocation(),
611 SourceLocation(),
612 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000613 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000614 TTP->isParameterPack()));
615 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000616 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
617 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
618 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
619 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
620 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000621 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
622 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000623 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
624 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
625 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
626 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
627 }
628
629 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000630 SourceLocation(),
631 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000632 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000633 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000634 T,
635 TInfo,
636 ExpandedTypes.data(),
637 ExpandedTypes.size(),
638 ExpandedTInfos.data());
639 } else {
640 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000641 SourceLocation(),
642 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000643 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000644 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000645 T,
646 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
647 TInfo);
648 }
649 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
650
651 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000652 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
653 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
654 }
655
656 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
657 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
658 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000659 TTP->getPosition(),
660 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000661 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000662 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
663 SourceLocation(),
David Majnemer902f8c62015-12-27 07:16:27 +0000664 CanonParams,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000665 SourceLocation()));
666
667 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
668 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000669 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000670 (void)Canonical;
671
672 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
673 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
674 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
675 return CanonTTP;
676}
677
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000678CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000679 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000680
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000681 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000682 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000683 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000684 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +0000685 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000686 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +0000687 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000688 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +0000689 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000690 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000691 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000692 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
693 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000694 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000695}
696
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000697static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000698 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
699 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
700 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
701 // language-specific address space.
702 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
703 1, // opencl_global
704 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000705 3, // opencl_constant
Anastasia Stulova2c8dcfb2014-11-26 14:10:06 +0000706 4, // opencl_generic
707 5, // cuda_device
708 6, // cuda_constant
709 7 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000710 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000711 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000712 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000713 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000714 }
715}
716
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000717static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
718 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
719 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000720 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
721 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
722 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
723 return true;
724 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
725 return false;
726 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000727 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000728}
729
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000730ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000731 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000732 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000733 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
734 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
735 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
736 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr), Int128Decl(nullptr),
737 UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr),
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +0000738 BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr), BuiltinMSVaListDecl(nullptr),
739 ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr), ObjCClassDecl(nullptr),
740 ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000741 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr),
742 FILEDecl(nullptr), jmp_bufDecl(nullptr), sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr),
743 ucontext_tDecl(nullptr), BlockDescriptorType(nullptr),
744 BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr), cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr),
Richard Smithf19e1272015-03-07 00:04:49 +0000745 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(), ExternCContext(nullptr),
David Majnemerd9b1a4f2015-11-04 03:40:30 +0000746 MakeIntegerSeqDecl(nullptr), SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Alexey Samsonova511cdd2015-02-04 17:40:08 +0000747 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000748 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), AuxTarget(nullptr),
749 PrintingPolicy(LOpts), Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
750 BuiltinInfo(builtins), DeclarationNames(*this), ExternalSource(nullptr),
751 Listener(nullptr), Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000752 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000753 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
754}
755
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000756ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000757 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
758
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000759 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
760 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
761 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000762
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000763 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000764 for (auto &Pair : Deallocations)
765 (Pair.first)(Pair.second);
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000766
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000767 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000768 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
769 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
770 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
771 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
772 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
773 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
774 R->Destroy(*this);
775
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000776 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
777 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
778 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
779 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
780 R->Destroy(*this);
781 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000782
783 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
784 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
785 A != AEnd; ++A)
786 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000787
David Majnemere694f3e2015-08-14 14:43:50 +0000788 for (std::pair<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue *> &MTVPair :
789 MaterializedTemporaryValues)
790 MTVPair.second->~APValue();
791
Reid Kleckner588c9372014-02-19 23:44:52 +0000792 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000793}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000794
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000795void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +0000796 if (!PointerParents) return;
797 for (const auto &Entry : *PointerParents) {
798 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
799 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
800 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
801 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
802 }
803 }
804 for (const auto &Entry : *OtherParents) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000805 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
806 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +0000807 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000808 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
809 }
810 }
811}
812
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000813void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000814 Deallocations.push_back({Callback, Data});
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000815}
816
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000817void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000818ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
819 ExternalSource = Source;
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000820}
821
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000822void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000823 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
824 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000825
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000826 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000827#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000828#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
829#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
830 0 // Extra
831 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000832
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000833 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
834 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000835 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000836 }
837
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000838 unsigned Idx = 0;
839 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
840#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
841 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000842 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
843 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000844 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
845 ++Idx;
846#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
847#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000848
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000849 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
850
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000851 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000852 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
853 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
854 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
855 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
856 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
857 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000858 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000859 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
860 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
861 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
862 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
863 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
864 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000865 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000866 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
867 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
868 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
869 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
870 << NumImplicitDestructors
871 << " implicit destructors created\n";
872
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000873 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000874 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000875 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
876 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000877
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000878 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000879}
880
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000881void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
882 bool NotifyListeners) {
883 if (NotifyListeners)
884 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
885 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
886
887 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
888 MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M);
889 else
890 ND->setHidden(false);
891}
892
893void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
894 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND);
895 if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
896 return;
897
898 auto &Merged = It->second;
899 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
900 for (Module *&M : Merged)
901 if (!Found.insert(M).second)
902 M = nullptr;
903 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
904}
905
Richard Smithf19e1272015-03-07 00:04:49 +0000906ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
907 if (!ExternCContext)
908 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
909
910 return ExternCContext;
911}
912
David Majnemerd9b1a4f2015-11-04 03:40:30 +0000913BuiltinTemplateDecl *
914ASTContext::buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK,
915 const IdentifierInfo *II) const {
916 auto *BuiltinTemplate = BuiltinTemplateDecl::Create(*this, TUDecl, II, BTK);
917 BuiltinTemplate->setImplicit();
918 TUDecl->addDecl(BuiltinTemplate);
919
920 return BuiltinTemplate;
921}
922
923BuiltinTemplateDecl *
924ASTContext::getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const {
925 if (!MakeIntegerSeqDecl)
926 MakeIntegerSeqDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__make_integer_seq,
927 getMakeIntegerSeqName());
928 return MakeIntegerSeqDecl;
929}
930
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000931RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
932 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000933 SourceLocation Loc;
934 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000935 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
936 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
937 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000938 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000939 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
940 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000941 NewDecl->setImplicit();
David Majnemerf8637362015-01-15 08:41:25 +0000942 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
943 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000944 return NewDecl;
945}
946
947TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
948 StringRef Name) const {
949 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
950 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
951 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
952 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
953 NewDecl->setImplicit();
954 return NewDecl;
955}
956
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000957TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000958 if (!Int128Decl)
959 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000960 return Int128Decl;
961}
962
963TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000964 if (!UInt128Decl)
965 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000966 return UInt128Decl;
967}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000968
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000969TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
Nico Weber5b0b46f2013-06-21 01:29:36 +0000970 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000971 if (!Float128StubDecl)
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000972 Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000973
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000974 return Float128StubDecl;
975}
976
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000977void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000978 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000979 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000980 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000981}
982
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000983void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target,
984 const TargetInfo *AuxTarget) {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000985 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
986 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000987 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000988
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000989 this->Target = &Target;
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000990 this->AuxTarget = AuxTarget;
991
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000992 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
993 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000994 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000995
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000996 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000997 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000998
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000999 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001000 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001001 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +00001002 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +00001003 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
1004 else
1005 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001006 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001007 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
1008 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
1009 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
1010 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
1011 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001012
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001013 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001014 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
1015 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
1016 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
1017 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
1018 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001019
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001020 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001021 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
1022 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
1023 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001024
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00001025 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
1026 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
1027 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
1028
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +00001029 // C++ 3.9.1p5
1030 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
1031 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1032 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1033 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1034 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1035 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1036 else {
1037 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1038 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1039 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001040
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +00001041 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1042
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001043 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1044 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
1045 else // C99
1046 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1047
1048 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1049 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
1050 else // C99
1051 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1052
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001053 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1054 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1055 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1056 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1057 // expressions.
1058 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001059
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00001060 // Placeholder type for functions.
1061 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1062
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001063 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1064 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1065
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001066 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1067 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1068
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001069 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1070 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1071
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001072 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1073 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1074
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001075 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1076 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1077
Alexey Bataev1a3320e2015-08-25 14:24:04 +00001078 // Placeholder type for OMP array sections.
1079 if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
1080 InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection);
1081
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001082 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001083 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1084 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1085 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001086
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001087 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001088 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1089 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001090 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001091
1092 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1093 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1094 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1095 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1096 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1097 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001098 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dDepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth);
1099 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayDepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth);
1100 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dMSAATy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA);
1101 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayMSAATy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA);
1102 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dMSAADepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth);
1103 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepthTy,
1104 BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001105 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001106
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001107 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001108 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001109 InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
1110 InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
1111 InitBuiltinType(OCLNDRangeTy, BuiltinType::OCLNDRange);
1112 InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001113 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001114
1115 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001116 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1117 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001118
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001119 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001120
1121 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001122
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001123 // void * type
1124 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001125
1126 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1127 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001128
1129 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1130 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001131
1132 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00001133 VaListTagDecl = nullptr;
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001134}
1135
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001136DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001137 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1138}
1139
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001140AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1141 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1142 if (!Result) {
1143 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1144 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1145 }
1146
1147 return *Result;
1148}
1149
1150/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1151void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1152 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1153 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1154 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1155 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1156 }
1157}
1158
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001159// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001160MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001161ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001162 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001163 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1164 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1165}
1166
1167ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1168ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1169 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1170 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1171 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1172 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001173
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001174 return Pos->second;
1175}
1176
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001177void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001178ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001179 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1180 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001181 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1182 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001183 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1184 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1185}
1186
1187void
1188ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1189 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1190 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1191 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1192 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001193}
1194
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001195FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1196 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1197 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1198 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001199 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1200 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001201 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001202
1203 return Pos->second;
1204}
1205
1206void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1207 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1208 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1209 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001210 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001211}
1212
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001213NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001214ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001215 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001216 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1217 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001218 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001219
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001220 return Pos->second;
1221}
1222
1223void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001224ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1225 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1226 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1227 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1228 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1229 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1230 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1231}
1232
1233UsingShadowDecl *
1234ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1235 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1236 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1237 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001238 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001239
1240 return Pos->second;
1241}
1242
1243void
1244ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1245 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1246 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1247 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001248}
1249
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001250FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1251 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1252 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1253 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001254 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001255
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001256 return Pos->second;
1257}
1258
1259void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1260 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1261 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1262 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1263 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1264 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001265
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001266 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1267}
1268
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001269ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1270ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1271 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001272 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001273 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001274 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001275
1276 return Pos->second.begin();
1277}
1278
1279ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1280ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1281 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001282 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001283 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001284 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001285
1286 return Pos->second.end();
1287}
1288
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001289unsigned
1290ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1291 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001292 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001293 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1294 return 0;
1295
1296 return Pos->second.size();
1297}
1298
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001299void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1300 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001301 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001302 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1303}
1304
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001305void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1306 const NamedDecl *D,
1307 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001308 assert(D);
1309
1310 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001311 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1312 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001313 return;
1314 }
1315
1316 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1317 if (!Method)
1318 return;
1319
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001320 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1321 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001322 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001323}
1324
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001325void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1326 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1327 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1328 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1329 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1330 LastLocalImport = Import;
1331 return;
1332 }
1333
1334 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1335 LastLocalImport = Import;
1336}
1337
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001338//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1339// Type Sizing and Analysis
1340//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001341
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001342/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1343/// scalar floating point type.
1344const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001345 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001346 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1347 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001348 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001349 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001350 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1351 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1352 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001353 }
1354}
1355
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001356CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001357 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001358
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001359 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1360 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1361 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001362
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001363 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1364 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1365 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1366 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001367 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001368 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1369 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1370 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1371 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1372 } else {
1373 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1374 }
1375 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001376 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1377 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1378 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1379 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001380
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001381 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1382 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001383 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001384 // do nothing
1385
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001386 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001387 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001388 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001389 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001390 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1391 else
1392 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1393 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001394 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1395 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001396 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1397 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001398 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001399 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1400 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001401 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1402 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1403 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1404 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1405 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1406 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001407 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001408 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001409 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Ulrich Weigandb63f7792015-04-21 17:26:18 +00001410 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001411 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1412 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001413 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001414
1415 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1416 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1417 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1418 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1419 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001420 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1421 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1422 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1423 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1424 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001425
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001426 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1427 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001428
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001429 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1430 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1431 if (Offset > 0) {
1432 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1433 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1434 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1435 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1436 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1437 }
1438
1439 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001440 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001441 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001442 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001443
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001444 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001445}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001446
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001447// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1448// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1449// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1450// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1451std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1452ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1453 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1454
1455 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1456 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1457 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1458 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1459 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1460 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1461 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1462 }
1463 }
1464
1465 return sizeAndAlign;
1466}
1467
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001468/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1469/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1470std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1471static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1472 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1473 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1474 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1475 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001476 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1477 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001478 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1479 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1480 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001481 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1482 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1483 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001484 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1485 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1486}
1487
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001488std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001489ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001490 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1491 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001492 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1493 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1494 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001495}
1496
1497std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001498ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001499 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1500}
1501
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001502bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1503 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1504}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001505
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001506bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1507 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1508}
1509
1510TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemerf8d38642014-07-30 08:42:33 +00001511 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1512 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1513 return I->second;
1514
1515 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1516 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1517 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
Rafael Espindolaeaa88c12014-07-30 04:40:23 +00001518 return TI;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001519}
1520
1521/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1522/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001523///
1524/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1525/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1526/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001527TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1528 uint64_t Width = 0;
1529 unsigned Align = 8;
1530 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001531 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001532#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1533#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001534#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001535#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001536#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1537 case Type::Class: \
1538 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1539 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001540#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001541 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001542
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001543 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1544 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001545 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1546 Width = 0;
1547 Align = 32;
1548 break;
1549
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001550 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001551 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001552 Width = 0;
1553 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1554 break;
1555
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001556 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001557 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001558
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001559 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001560 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001561 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001562 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001563 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1564 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001565 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1566 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1567 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001568 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001569 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001570 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001571 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001572 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001573 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1574 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001575 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001576 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1577 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001578 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001579 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1580 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1581 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001582 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1583 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1584 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1585 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001586 break;
1587 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001588
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001589 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001590 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001591 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001592 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001593 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1594 Width = 0;
1595 Align = 8;
1596 break;
1597
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001598 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001599 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1600 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001601 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001602 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1603 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1604 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001605 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001606 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1607 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001608 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001609 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1610 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001611 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1612 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001613 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001614 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001615 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1616 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001617 break;
1618 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001619 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1620 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001621 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001622 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001623 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001624 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1625 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001626 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001627 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001628 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001629 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1630 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001631 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001632 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001633 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001634 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1635 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001636 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001637 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001638 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001639 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1640 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001641 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001642 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1643 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1644 Width = 128;
1645 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1646 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001647 case BuiltinType::Half:
1648 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1649 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1650 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001651 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001652 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1653 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001654 break;
1655 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001656 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1657 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001658 break;
1659 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001660 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1661 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001662 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001663 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001664 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1665 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001666 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001667 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1668 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1669 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001670 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1671 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001672 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001673 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1674 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1675 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1676 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1677 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001678 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001679 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
1680 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
1681 case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange:
1682 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001683 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1684 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1685 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1686 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1687 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001688 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth:
1689 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth:
1690 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA:
1691 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA:
1692 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth:
1693 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001694 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1695 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1696 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1697 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1698 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001699 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001700 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001701 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001702 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1703 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001704 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001705 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001706 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1707 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001708 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1709 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001710 break;
1711 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001712 case Type::LValueReference:
1713 case Type::RValueReference: {
1714 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1715 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001716 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1717 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001718 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1719 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001720 break;
1721 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001722 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001723 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001724 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1725 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001726 break;
1727 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001728 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001729 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001730 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001731 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001732 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001733 case Type::Complex: {
1734 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1735 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001736 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1737 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1738 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001739 break;
1740 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001741 case Type::ObjCObject:
1742 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001743 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001744 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001745 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001746 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001747 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001748 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001749 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001750 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001751 break;
1752 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001753 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001754 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001755 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1756
1757 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001758 Width = 8;
1759 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001760 break;
1761 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001762
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001763 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1764 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1765 TypeInfo Info =
1766 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1767 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1768 Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1769 Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1770 }
1771 return Info;
1772 }
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001773
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001774 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001775 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1776 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001777 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001778 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001779 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001780 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001781 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001782
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001783 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001784 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1785 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001786
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001787 case Type::Auto: {
1788 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001789 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1790 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001791 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001792 }
1793
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001794 case Type::Paren:
1795 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1796
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001797 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001798 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001799 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001800 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1801 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1802 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001803 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001804 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001805 AlignIsRequired = true;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001806 } else {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001807 Align = Info.Align;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001808 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1809 }
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001810 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001811 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001812 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001813
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001814 case Type::Elaborated:
1815 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001816
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001817 case Type::Attributed:
1818 return getTypeInfo(
1819 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1820
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001821 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001822 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001823 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1824 Width = Info.Width;
1825 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001826
1827 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1828 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1829 // favorable to atomic operations:
1830 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1831 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1832 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1833 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1834
1835 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001836 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1837 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001838 }
1839
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001840 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001841
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001842 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001843 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001844}
1845
Alexey Bataev00396512015-07-02 03:40:19 +00001846unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
1847 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
1848 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32.
1849 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 ||
1850 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) &&
1851 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" &&
1852 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
1853 SimdAlign = 256;
1854 return SimdAlign;
1855}
1856
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001857/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1858CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1859 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1860}
1861
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001862/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1863int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1864 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1865}
1866
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001867/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1868/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001869CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001870 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001871}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001872CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001873 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001874}
1875
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001876/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001877/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001878CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001879 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001880}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001881CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001882 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001883}
1884
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001885/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1886/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1887/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1888/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001889unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001890 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1891 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001892
David Majnemere1544562015-04-24 01:25:05 +00001893 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1894
1895 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
1896 if (T->isMemberPointerType())
1897 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
1898
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001899 if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1900 return ABIAlign; // Never overalign on XCore.
1901
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001902 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00001903 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001904 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001905 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
1906 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001907 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001908 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1909 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001910 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1911 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001912 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001913 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001914
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001915 return ABIAlign;
1916}
1917
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00001918/// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
1919/// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
1920/// value is specified.
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00001921unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const {
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00001922 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
1923}
1924
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001925/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1926/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1927unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1928 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1929}
1930
1931/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1932/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1933CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1934 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1935}
1936
David Majnemer08ef2ba2015-06-23 20:34:18 +00001937CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
1938 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
1939 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
1940 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
1941 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
1942 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
1943 }
1944 return Offset;
1945}
1946
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001947/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1948/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1949/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1950/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1951/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001952///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001953void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1954 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001955 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001956 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1957 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1958 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00001959 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1960 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001961 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001962 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001963 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001964 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1965 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1966 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001967}
1968
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001969/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1970/// those inherited by it.
1971void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001972 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001973 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001974 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1975 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00001976 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00001977 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001978 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001979
1980 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00001981 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1982 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001983
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001984 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1985 while (SD) {
1986 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1987 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1988 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001989 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00001990 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00001991 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001992 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001993 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00001994 // Insert the protocol.
1995 if (!Protocols.insert(
1996 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
1997 return;
1998
1999 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
2000 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002001 }
2002}
2003
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002004unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002005 unsigned count = 0;
2006 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00002007 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002008 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002009
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002010 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
2011 // includes synthesized ivars.
2012 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002013 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
2014
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00002015 return count;
2016}
2017
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00002018bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
2019 if (!E)
2020 return false;
2021
2022 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
2023 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
2024
2025 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
2026 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
2027 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2028 return true;
2029
2030 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
2031 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
2032
2033 return false;
2034}
2035
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002036/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
2037ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
2038 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2039 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2040 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2041 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002042 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002043}
2044/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
2045ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
2046 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2047 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2048 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2049 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002050 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002051}
2052
2053/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
2054void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2055 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2056 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2057 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2058}
2059/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
2060void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2061 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2062 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2063 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2064}
2065
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00002066const ObjCMethodDecl *
2067ASTContext::getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) const {
2068 return ObjCMethodRedecls.lookup(MD);
2069}
2070
2071void ASTContext::setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD,
2072 const ObjCMethodDecl *Redecl) {
2073 assert(!getObjCMethodRedeclaration(MD) && "MD already has a redeclaration");
2074 ObjCMethodRedecls[MD] = Redecl;
2075}
2076
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002077const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2078 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2079 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
2080 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002081 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002082 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
2083 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002084 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002085 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
2086 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002087 return IMD->getClassInterface();
2088
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002089 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002090}
2091
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002092/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
2093/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002094Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002095 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2096 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2097 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002098 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002099 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002100 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002101}
2102
2103/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
2104void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
2105 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002106 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2107 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002108 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
2109}
2110
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002111TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002112 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002113 if (!DataSize)
2114 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2115 else
2116 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002117 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002118
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002119 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2120 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2121 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2122 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00002123}
2124
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002125TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00002126 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002127 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00002128 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00002129 return DI;
2130}
2131
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002132const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002133ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002134 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002135}
2136
2137const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002138ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2139 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002140 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2141}
2142
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002143//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2144// Type creation/memoization methods
2145//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2146
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002147QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002148ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2149 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2150 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002151
2152 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2153 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002154 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002155 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002156 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2157 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2158 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002159 }
2160
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002161 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2162 QualType canon;
2163 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2164 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002165 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2166 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002167
2168 // Re-find the insert position.
2169 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2170 }
2171
2172 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2173 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2174 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002175}
2176
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002177QualType
2178ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002179 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2180 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002181 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002182
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002183 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2184 // into one ExtQuals node.
2185 QualifierCollector Quals;
2186 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002187
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002188 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2189 // another one.
2190 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2191 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2192 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002193
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002194 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002195}
2196
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002197QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002198 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002199 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002200 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002201 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002202
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002203 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2204 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002205 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002206 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2207 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2208 }
2209 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002210
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002211 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2212 // into one ExtQuals node.
2213 QualifierCollector Quals;
2214 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002215
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002216 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2217 // another one.
2218 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2219 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2220 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002221
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002222 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002223}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002224
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002225const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2226 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2227 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2228 return T;
2229
2230 QualType Result;
2231 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002232 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002233 } else {
2234 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2235 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2236 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002237 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002238 }
2239
2240 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2241}
2242
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002243void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2244 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002245 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2246 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002247 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2248 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002249 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002250 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2251 FD = Next;
2252 else
2253 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002254 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002255 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2256 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002257}
2258
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002259/// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2260/// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2261/// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2262/// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
2263static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2264 ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2265 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2266 // Might have some parens.
2267 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2268 return Context.getParenType(
2269 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2270
2271 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2272 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2273 return Context.getAttributedType(
2274 AT->getAttrKind(),
2275 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2276 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2277 ESI));
2278
2279 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2280 // specification.
2281 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2282 return Context.getFunctionType(
2283 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2284 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2285}
2286
2287void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2288 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2289 bool AsWritten) {
2290 // Update the type.
2291 QualType Updated =
2292 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2293 FD->setType(Updated);
2294
2295 if (!AsWritten)
2296 return;
2297
2298 // Update the type in the type source information too.
2299 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2300 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2301 // the type-as-written too.
2302 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2303 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2304
2305 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2306 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2307 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2308 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2309 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2310 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2311 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2312 }
2313}
2314
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002315/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2316/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002317QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002318 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2319 // structure.
2320 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2321 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002322
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002323 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002324 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2325 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002326
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002327 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2328 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2329 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002330 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002331 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002332
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002333 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2334 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002335 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002336 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002337 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002338 Types.push_back(New);
2339 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2340 return QualType(New, 0);
2341}
2342
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002343/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2344/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002345QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002346 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2347 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002348 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002349 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002350
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002351 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002352 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002353 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002354
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002355 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2356 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002357 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002358 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002359 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002360
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002361 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2362 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002363 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002364 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002365 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002366 Types.push_back(New);
2367 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002368 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002369}
2370
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002371QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2372 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2373 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002374 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002375 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2376 if (AT)
2377 return QualType(AT, 0);
2378
2379 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2380
2381 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2382 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002383 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002384
2385 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2386 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2387 Types.push_back(AT);
2388 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2389 return QualType(AT, 0);
2390}
2391
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002392QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2393 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2394
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002395 QualType Decayed;
2396
2397 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2398 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2399 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2400 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2401 // the array type derivation.
2402 if (T->isArrayType())
2403 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2404
2405 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2406 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2407 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2408 // in 6.3.2.1.
2409 if (T->isFunctionType())
2410 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2411
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002412 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2413 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002414 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002415 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2416 if (AT)
2417 return QualType(AT, 0);
2418
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002419 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2420
2421 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002422 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002423 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002424
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002425 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2426 Types.push_back(AT);
2427 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2428 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002429}
2430
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002431/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002432/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002433QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002434 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2435 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002436 // structure.
2437 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2438 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002439
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002440 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002441 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2442 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2443 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002444
2445 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002446 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2447 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002448 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002449 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002450
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002451 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2452 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2453 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002454 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002455 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002456 BlockPointerType *New
2457 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002458 Types.push_back(New);
2459 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2460 return QualType(New, 0);
2461}
2462
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002463/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2464/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002465QualType
2466ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002467 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2468 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2469
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002470 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2471 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002472 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002473 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002474
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002475 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002476 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2477 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002478 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002479
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002480 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2481
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002482 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2483 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2484 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002485 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2486 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2487 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002488
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002489 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002490 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2491 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002492 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002493 }
2494
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002495 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002496 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2497 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002498 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002499 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002500
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002501 return QualType(New, 0);
2502}
2503
2504/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2505/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002506QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002507 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2508 // structure.
2509 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002510 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002511
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002512 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002513 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2514 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2515 return QualType(RT, 0);
2516
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002517 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2518
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002519 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2520 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2521 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002522 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2523 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2524 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002525
2526 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2527 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2528 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002529 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002530 }
2531
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002532 RValueReferenceType *New
2533 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002534 Types.push_back(New);
2535 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002536 return QualType(New, 0);
2537}
2538
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002539/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2540/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002541QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002542 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2543 // structure.
2544 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2545 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2546
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002547 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002548 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2549 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2550 return QualType(PT, 0);
2551
2552 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2553 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2554 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002555 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002556 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2557
2558 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2559 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2560 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002561 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002562 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002563 MemberPointerType *New
2564 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002565 Types.push_back(New);
2566 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2567 return QualType(New, 0);
2568}
2569
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002570/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002571/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002572QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002573 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002574 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002575 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002576 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2577 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002578 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2579
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002580 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2581 // the target.
2582 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002583 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002584 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002585
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002586 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002587 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002588
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002589 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002590 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002591 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002592 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002593
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002594 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2595 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2596 QualType Canon;
2597 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2598 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002599 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002600 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002601 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002602
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002603 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002604 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002605 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002606 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002607 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002608
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002609 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002610 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002611 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002612 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002613 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002614}
2615
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002616/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2617/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2618/// sizes replaced with [*].
2619QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2620 // Vastly most common case.
2621 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002622
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002623 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002624
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002625 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002626 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002627 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2628#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2629#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2630#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2631#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2632 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2633
2634 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2635 case Type::Builtin:
2636 case Type::Complex:
2637 case Type::Vector:
2638 case Type::ExtVector:
2639 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2640 case Type::ObjCObject:
2641 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2642 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2643 case Type::Record:
2644 case Type::Enum:
2645 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2646 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2647 case Type::TypeOf:
2648 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002649 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002650 case Type::DependentName:
2651 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2652 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2653 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2654 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2655 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002656 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002657 case Type::PackExpansion:
2658 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2659
2660 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2661 // further decay.
2662 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2663 case Type::FunctionProto:
2664 case Type::BlockPointer:
2665 case Type::MemberPointer:
2666 return type;
2667
2668 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2669 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2670 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2671 // optimizations available here.
2672 case Type::Pointer:
2673 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2674 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2675 break;
2676
2677 case Type::LValueReference: {
2678 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2679 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2680 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2681 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2682 break;
2683 }
2684
2685 case Type::RValueReference: {
2686 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2687 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2688 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2689 break;
2690 }
2691
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002692 case Type::Atomic: {
2693 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2694 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2695 break;
2696 }
2697
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002698 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2699 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2700 result = getConstantArrayType(
2701 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2702 cat->getSize(),
2703 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2704 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2705 break;
2706 }
2707
2708 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2709 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2710 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2711 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2712 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2713 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2714 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2715 dat->getBracketsRange());
2716 break;
2717 }
2718
2719 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2720 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2721 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2722 result = getVariableArrayType(
2723 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002724 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002725 ArrayType::Normal,
2726 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2727 SourceRange());
2728 break;
2729 }
2730
2731 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2732 case Type::VariableArray: {
2733 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2734 result = getVariableArrayType(
2735 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002736 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002737 ArrayType::Star,
2738 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2739 vat->getBracketsRange());
2740 break;
2741 }
2742 }
2743
2744 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002745 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002746}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002747
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002748/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2749/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002750QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2751 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002752 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002753 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002754 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002755 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2756 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002757 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002758
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002759 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2760 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2761 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002762 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002763 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002764 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002765 }
2766
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002767 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002768 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002769
2770 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2771 Types.push_back(New);
2772 return QualType(New, 0);
2773}
2774
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002775/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2776/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002777/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002778QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2779 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002780 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002781 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2782 SourceRange brackets) const {
2783 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2784 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002785 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2786
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002787 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2788 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2789 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2790 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2791 if (!numElements) {
2792 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2793 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2794 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2795 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2796 brackets);
2797 Types.push_back(newType);
2798 return QualType(newType, 0);
2799 }
2800
2801 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2802 // also build a canonical type.
2803
2804 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2805
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002806 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002807 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002808 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002809 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002810 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002811
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002812 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2813 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2814 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002815
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002816 // If we don't have one, build one.
2817 if (!canonTy) {
2818 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002819 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002820 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2821 brackets);
2822 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2823 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002824 }
2825
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002826 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2827 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002828 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002829
David Majnemer16a74702015-07-24 05:54:19 +00002830 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size
2831 // expression, then just use that as our result.
2832 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType &&
2833 canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002834 return canon;
2835
2836 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2837 // of the element type.
2838 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2839 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2840 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2841 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2842 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2843 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002844}
2845
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002846QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002847 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002848 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002849 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002850 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002851
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002852 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002853 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2854 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2855 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002856
2857 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002858 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2859 // qualifiers off the element type.
2860 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002861
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002862 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2863 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002864 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002865 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002866 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002867
2868 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002869 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2870 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2871 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002872 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002873
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002874 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2875 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002876
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002877 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2878 Types.push_back(newType);
2879 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002880}
2881
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002882/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2883/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002884QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002885 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002886 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002887
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002888 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2889 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002890 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002891
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002892 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002893 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2894 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2895
2896 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2897 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2898 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002899 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002900 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002901
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002902 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2903 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002904 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002905 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002906 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002907 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002908 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2909 Types.push_back(New);
2910 return QualType(New, 0);
2911}
2912
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002913/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002914/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002915QualType
2916ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002917 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002918
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002919 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2920 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002921 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002922 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002923 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002924 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2925 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2926
2927 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2928 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2929 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002930 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002931 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002932
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002933 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2934 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002935 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002936 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002937 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2938 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002939 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2940 Types.push_back(New);
2941 return QualType(New, 0);
2942}
2943
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002944QualType
2945ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2946 Expr *SizeExpr,
2947 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002948 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002949 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002950 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002951
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002952 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002953 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2954 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2955 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2956 if (Canon) {
2957 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2958 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002959 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2960 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2961 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002962 } else {
2963 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2964 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002965 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2966 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2967 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002968
2969 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2970 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2971 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2972 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002973 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2974 } else {
2975 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2976 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002977 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2978 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002979 }
2980 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002981
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002982 Types.push_back(New);
2983 return QualType(New, 0);
2984}
2985
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002986/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002987///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002988QualType
2989ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2990 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002991 const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2992
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002993 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2994 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002995 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002996 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002997
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002998 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002999 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003000 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003001 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003002
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003003 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00003004 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
3005 Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003006
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003007 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003008 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
3009 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003010 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003011 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003012
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00003013 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003014 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00003015 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003016 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003017 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003018 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003019}
3020
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00003021/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
3022static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
3023 return T.isCanonical() &&
3024 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
3025 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
3026}
3027
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003028CanQualType
3029ASTContext::getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const {
3030 CanQualType CanResultType = getCanonicalType(ResultType);
3031
3032 // Canonical result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
3033 if (CanResultType.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
3034 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultType.getQualifiers();
3035 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
3036 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(
3037 getQualifiedType(CanResultType.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs));
3038 }
3039
3040 return CanResultType;
3041}
3042
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003043QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003044ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003045 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003046 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
3047
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003048 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3049 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00003050 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003051 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
3052 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003053
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003054 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003055 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003056 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003057 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003058
3059 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003060 bool isCanonical =
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003061 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003062 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003063 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003064 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003065 isCanonical = false;
3066
3067 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003068 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003069 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00003070 if (!isCanonical) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003071 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003072 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3073 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003074 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003075
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003076 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003077 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003078 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003079
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003080 // Adjust the canonical function result type.
3081 CanQualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy);
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003082 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003083
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003084 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003085 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
3086 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003087 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003088 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003089
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003090 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
3091 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
3092 // - parameter types
3093 // - exception types
3094 // - consumed-arguments flags
3095 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003096 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
3097 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003098 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003099 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003100 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3101 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3102 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00003103 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003104 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00003105 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003106 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003107 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003108 }
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00003109 if (EPI.ConsumedParameters)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003110 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
3111
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003112 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00003113 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003114 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003115 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003116 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003117 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003118}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00003119
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003120#ifndef NDEBUG
3121static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3122 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3123 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3124 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3125 return true;
3126 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3127 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3128 return true;
3129 return false;
3130}
3131#endif
3132
3133/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3134/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
3135QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003136 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003137 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3138 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3139 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003140 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003141 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3142 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3143 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3144 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003145 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003146 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003147 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3148 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003149 }
3150 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3151}
3152
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003153/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3154/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003155QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00003156 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003157 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003158
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003159 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003160 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003161
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003162 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3163 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3164
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003165 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003166 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003167 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003168 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003169 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003170 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003171 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003172 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00003173 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003174 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3175 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3176 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00003177 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003178 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003179
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003180 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003181}
3182
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00003183/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003184/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003185QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003186ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3187 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003188 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003189
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003190 if (Canonical.isNull())
3191 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003192 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003193 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003194 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3195 Types.push_back(newType);
3196 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00003197}
3198
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003199QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003200 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3201
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003202 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003203 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3204 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3205
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003206 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3207 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3208 Types.push_back(newType);
3209 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003210}
3211
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003212QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003213 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3214
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003215 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003216 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3217 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3218
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003219 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3220 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3221 Types.push_back(newType);
3222 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003223}
3224
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003225QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3226 QualType modifiedType,
3227 QualType equivalentType) {
3228 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3229 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3230
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003231 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003232 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3233 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3234
3235 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3236 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3237 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3238
3239 Types.push_back(type);
3240 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3241
3242 return QualType(type, 0);
3243}
3244
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003245/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3246QualType
3247ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003248 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003249 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003250 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3251
3252 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3253 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003254 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003255 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3256 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3257
3258 if (!SubstParm) {
3259 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3260 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3261 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3262 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3263 }
3264
3265 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3266}
3267
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003268/// \brief Retrieve a
3269QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3270 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3271 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3272#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003273 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3274 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3275 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003276 }
3277#endif
3278
3279 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3280 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003281 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003282 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3283 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3284 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3285
3286 QualType Canon;
3287 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3288 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3289 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3290 ArgPack);
3291 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3292 }
3293
3294 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3295 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3296 ArgPack);
3297 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3298 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3299 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3300}
3301
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003302/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003303/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003304/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003305QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003306 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003307 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003308 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003309 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003310 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003311 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003312 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3313
3314 if (TypeParm)
3315 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003316
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003317 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003318 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003319 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003320
3321 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3322 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3323 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3324 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003325 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003326 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3327 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003328
3329 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3330 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3331
3332 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3333}
3334
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003335TypeSourceInfo *
3336ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3337 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3338 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003339 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003340 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3341 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003342 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003343
3344 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003345 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3346 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003347 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003348 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3349 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3350 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3351 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3352 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3353 return DI;
3354}
3355
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003356QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003357ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003358 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003359 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003360 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3361 "No dependent template names here!");
3362
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003363 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3364
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003365 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003366 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3367 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3368 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3369
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003370 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003371 Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003372}
3373
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003374#ifndef NDEBUG
3375static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3376 unsigned NumArgs) {
3377 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3378 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3379 return true;
3380
3381 return true;
3382}
3383#endif
3384
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003385QualType
3386ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003387 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3388 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003389 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003390 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3391 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003392 // Look through qualified template names.
3393 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3394 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003395
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003396 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003397 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3398 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003399 QualType CanonType;
3400 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3401 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3402 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003403 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3404 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3405 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3406 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3407 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003408 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3409 NumArgs);
3410 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003411
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003412 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3413 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3414 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003415 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3416 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003417 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003418 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003419 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003420 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3421 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003422
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003423 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003424 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003425}
3426
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003427QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003428ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3429 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003430 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003431 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3432 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003433
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003434 // Look through qualified template names.
3435 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3436 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003437
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003438 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3439 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003440 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003441 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3442 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3443 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3444
3445 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3446 // exists.
3447 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3448 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3449 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3450
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003451 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003452 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3453 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3454
3455 if (!Spec) {
3456 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3457 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3458 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3459 TypeAlignment);
3460 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3461 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003462 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003463 Types.push_back(Spec);
3464 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3465 }
3466
3467 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3468 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3469 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3470}
3471
3472QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003473ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3474 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003475 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003476 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003477 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003478
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003479 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003480 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003481 if (T)
3482 return QualType(T, 0);
3483
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003484 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3485 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3486 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003487 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3488 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003489 (void)CheckT;
3490 }
3491
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003492 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003493 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003494 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003495 return QualType(T, 0);
3496}
3497
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003498QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003499ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003500 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3501 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3502
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003503 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003504 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3505 if (T)
3506 return QualType(T, 0);
3507
3508 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3509 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3510 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3511 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3512 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3513 (void)CheckT;
3514 }
3515
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003516 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003517 Types.push_back(T);
3518 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3519 return QualType(T, 0);
3520}
3521
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003522QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3523 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3524 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003525 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003526 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3527 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003528 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3529 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3530 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3531
3532 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3533 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003534 }
3535
3536 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003537 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003538
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003539 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003540 DependentNameType *T
3541 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003542 if (T)
3543 return QualType(T, 0);
3544
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003545 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003546 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003547 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003548 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003549}
3550
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003551QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003552ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3553 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003554 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003555 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003556 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003557 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003558 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003559 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3560 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3561 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3562 ArgCopy.size(),
3563 ArgCopy.data());
3564}
3565
3566QualType
3567ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3568 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3569 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3570 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3571 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003572 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003573 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3574 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003575
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003576 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003577 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3578 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003579
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003580 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003581 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3582 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003583 if (T)
3584 return QualType(T, 0);
3585
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003586 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003587
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003588 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3589 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3590
3591 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003592 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003593 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3594 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3595 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3596 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003597 }
3598
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003599 QualType Canon;
3600 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3601 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3602 Name, NumArgs,
3603 CanonArgs.data());
3604
3605 // Find the insert position again.
3606 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3607 }
3608
3609 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3610 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3611 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003612 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003613 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003614 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003615 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003616 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003617}
3618
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003619QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003620 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003621 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003622 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003623
3624 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3625 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003626 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003627 PackExpansionType *T
3628 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3629 if (T)
3630 return QualType(T, 0);
3631
3632 QualType Canon;
3633 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003634 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3635 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3636 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3637 // parameters.
3638 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003639 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003640
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003641 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3642 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3643 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3644 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003645 }
3646
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003647 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3648 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003649 Types.push_back(T);
3650 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003651 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003652}
3653
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003654/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3655/// alphabetically.
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003656static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
3657 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
3658 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003659}
3660
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003661static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003662 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3663 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3664
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003665 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3666 return false;
3667
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003668 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003669 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003670 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003671 return false;
3672 return true;
3673}
3674
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003675static void
3676SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &Protocols) {
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003677 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003678 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end(), CmpProtocolNames);
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003679
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003680 // Canonicalize.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003681 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *&P : Protocols)
3682 P = P->getCanonicalDecl();
3683
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003684 // Remove duplicates.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003685 auto ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end());
3686 Protocols.erase(ProtocolsEnd, Protocols.end());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003687}
3688
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003689QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3690 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003691 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003692 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, { },
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003693 llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
3694 /*isKindOf=*/false);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003695}
3696
3697QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
3698 QualType baseType,
3699 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003700 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
3701 bool isKindOf) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003702 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
3703 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003704 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
3705 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003706 return baseType;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003707
3708 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003709 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003710 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003711 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003712 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3713 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003714
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003715 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
3716 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
3717 // type.
3718 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
3719 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
3720 if (auto baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
3721 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
3722 }
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003723
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003724 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
3725 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
3726 // canonicalized.
3727 QualType canonical;
3728 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(),
3729 effectiveTypeArgs.end(),
3730 [&](QualType type) {
3731 return type.isCanonical();
3732 });
3733 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols.data(),
3734 protocols.size());
3735 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
3736 // Determine the canonical type arguments.
3737 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
3738 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
3739 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
3740 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
3741 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
3742 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
3743 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003744 } else {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003745 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003746 }
3747
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003748 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
3749 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
3750 if (!protocolsSorted) {
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003751 canonProtocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
3752 SortAndUniqueProtocols(canonProtocolsVec);
3753 canonProtocols = canonProtocolsVec;
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003754 } else {
3755 canonProtocols = protocols;
3756 }
3757
3758 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003759 canonProtocols, isKindOf);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003760
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003761 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003762 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3763 }
3764
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003765 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3766 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3767 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3768 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003769 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003770 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
3771 isKindOf);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003772
3773 Types.push_back(T);
3774 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3775 return QualType(T, 0);
3776}
3777
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003778/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3779/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3780/// list.
3781bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3782 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3783 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3784 return false;
3785
3786 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3787 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003788 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003789 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3790 return false;
3791 }
3792 return true;
3793 }
3794 return false;
3795}
3796
3797/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3798/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3799/// of protocols.
3800bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3801 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3802 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3803 return false;
3804 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3805 if (!OPT)
3806 return false;
3807 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3808 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003809 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3810 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3811 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3812 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003813 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3814 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3815 bool Conforms = false;
3816 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3817 Conforms = false;
3818 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3819 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3820 Conforms = true;
3821 break;
3822 }
3823 }
3824 if (!Conforms)
3825 break;
3826 }
3827 if (Conforms)
3828 return true;
3829
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003830 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003831 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3832 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003833 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003834 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003835 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003836 break;
3837 }
3838 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003839 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003840 }
3841 return true;
3842}
3843
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003844/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3845/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003846QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003847 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3848 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3849
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003850 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003851 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3852 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3853 return QualType(QT, 0);
3854
3855 // Find the canonical object type.
3856 QualType Canonical;
3857 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3858 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3859
3860 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003861 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3862 }
3863
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003864 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003865 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3866 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3867 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003868
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003869 Types.push_back(QType);
3870 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003871 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003872}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003873
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003874/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3875/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003876QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3877 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003878 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3879 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003880
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003881 if (PrevDecl) {
3882 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3883 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3884 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3885 }
3886
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003887 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3888 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3889 Decl = Def;
3890
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003891 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3892 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3893 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3894 Types.push_back(T);
3895 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003896}
3897
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003898/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3899/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003900/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003901/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003902/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003903QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003904 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003905 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3906 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3907 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003908
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003909 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003910 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3911 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3912 if (Canon) {
3913 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3914 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003915 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003916 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003917 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003918 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003919 Canon
3920 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003921 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3922 toe = Canon;
3923 }
3924 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003925 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003926 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003927 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003928 Types.push_back(toe);
3929 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003930}
3931
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003932/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003933/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003934/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003935/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3936/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003937QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003938 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003939 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003940 Types.push_back(tot);
3941 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003942}
3943
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003944/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3945/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3946/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3947/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003948QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003949 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003950
3951 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003952 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003953 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3954 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003955 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003956 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3957 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003958
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003959 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003960 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3961 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003962 if (!Canon) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003963 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003964 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003965 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003966 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003967 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3968 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003969 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003970 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3971 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003972 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003973 Types.push_back(dt);
3974 return QualType(dt, 0);
3975}
3976
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003977/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3978/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3979QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3980 QualType UnderlyingType,
3981 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3982 const {
3983 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor6c6e6762011-05-25 17:51:54 +00003984 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3985 Kind,
3986 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne15d48ec2012-03-05 16:02:06 +00003987 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003988 Types.push_back(Ty);
3989 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3990}
3991
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003992/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3993/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3994/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00003995QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003996 bool IsDependent) const {
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00003997 if (DeducedType.isNull() && Keyword == AutoTypeKeyword::Auto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003998 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003999
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004000 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004001 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004002 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004003 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004004 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4005 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004006
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00004007 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004008 Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004009 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004010 Types.push_back(AT);
4011 if (InsertPos)
4012 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
4013 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00004014}
4015
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004016/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
4017/// the given value type.
4018QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
4019 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
4020 // structure.
4021 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4022 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
4023
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004024 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004025 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4026 return QualType(AT, 0);
4027
4028 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
4029 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
4030 QualType Canonical;
4031 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
4032 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
4033
4034 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4035 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004036 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004037 }
4038 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
4039 Types.push_back(New);
4040 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4041 return QualType(New, 0);
4042}
4043
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004044/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
4045QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
4046 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004047 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004048 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::Auto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004049 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004050 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004051 return AutoDeductTy;
4052}
4053
4054/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
4055QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
4056 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
4057 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
4058 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
4059 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
4060}
4061
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004062/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4063/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004064QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00004065 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00004066 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
4067 // away const? mutable?
4068 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004069}
4070
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004071/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
4072/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
4073/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00004074CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004075 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00004076}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004077
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004078/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4079CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
4080 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
4081}
4082
4083/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4084CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
4085 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
4086}
4087
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00004088/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
4089/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4090QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
4091 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4092 return WCharTy;
4093}
4094
4095/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
4096/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4097QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
4098 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4099 return UnsignedIntTy;
4100}
4101
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00004102QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
4103 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
4104}
4105
4106QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
4107 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
4108}
4109
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004110/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004111/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
4112QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004113 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004114}
4115
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00004116/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
4117/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
4118QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
4119 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
4120}
4121
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004122//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4123// Type Operators
4124//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4125
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004126CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004127 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
4128 // qualifiers.
4129 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00004130 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004131 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004132 QualType Result;
4133 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
4134 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
4135 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
4136 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
4137 } else {
4138 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
4139 }
4140
4141 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
4142}
4143
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004144QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
4145 Qualifiers &quals) {
4146 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
4147
4148 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
4149 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
4150 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
4151 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
4152 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004153 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004154
4155 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004156 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004157 quals = splitType.Quals;
4158 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004159 }
4160
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004161 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4162 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4163 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4164
4165 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4166 // can just use the results in splitType.
4167 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4168 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004169 quals = splitType.Quals;
4170 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004171 }
4172
4173 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4174 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004175 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004176
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004177 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004178 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004179 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4180 }
4181
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004182 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004183 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004184 }
4185
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004186 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004187 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004188 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004189 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4190 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4191 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4192 }
4193
4194 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004195 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004196 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4197 SourceRange());
4198}
4199
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004200/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
4201/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4202/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4203/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4204/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4205/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4206/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4207/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4208bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4209 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4210 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4211 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4212 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4213 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4214 return true;
4215 }
4216
4217 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4218 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4219 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4220 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4221 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4222 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4223 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4224 return true;
4225 }
4226
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004227 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004228 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4229 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4230 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4231 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4232 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4233 return true;
4234 }
4235 }
4236
4237 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4238
4239 return false;
4240}
4241
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004242DeclarationNameInfo
4243ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4244 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004245 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4246 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4247 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004248 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004249 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4250 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004251
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004252 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4253 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4254 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4255 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4256 }
4257
4258 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4259 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004260 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004261 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004262 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4263 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004264 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004265 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4266 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4267 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4268 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4269 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4270 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004271 }
4272 }
4273
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004274 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4275 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4276 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4277 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4278 NameLoc);
4279 }
4280
4281 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4282 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4283 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4284 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4285 NameLoc);
4286 }
4287 }
4288
4289 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004290}
4291
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004292TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004293 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4294 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4295 case TemplateName::Template: {
4296 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004297 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004298 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004299 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4300
4301 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004302 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004303 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004304
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004305 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4306 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004307
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004308 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4309 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4310 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4311 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4312 }
4313
4314 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4315 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4316 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4317 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4318 }
4319
4320 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4321 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4322 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4323 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4324 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4325 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4326 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4327 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4328 }
4329 }
4330
4331 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004332}
4333
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004334bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4335 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4336 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4337 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4338}
4339
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004340TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004341ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004342 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4343 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4344 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004345
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004346 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004347 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004348
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004349 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004350 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
David Blaikie952a9b12014-10-17 18:00:12 +00004351 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004352 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004353
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004354 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4355 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4356 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4357
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004358 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4359 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004360
4361 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4362 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4363 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004364 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004365
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004366 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004367 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004368
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004369 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004370 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004371
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004372 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004373 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4374 return Arg;
4375
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004376 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4377 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004378 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004379 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004380 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4381 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4382 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004383
Benjamin Kramercce63472015-08-05 09:40:22 +00004384 return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size()));
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004385 }
4386 }
4387
4388 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004389 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004390}
4391
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004392NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004393ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004394 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004395 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004396
4397 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4398 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4399 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004400 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004401 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4402 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4403
4404 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4405 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4406 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004407 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004408 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4409
4410 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4411 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4412 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004413 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004414 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4415 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004416
4417 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4418 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4419 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004420
4421 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4422 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4423 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4424 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4425 // types, e.g.,
4426 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4427 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004428 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4429 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004430 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004431
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004432 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4433 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4434 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004435 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4436 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004437 }
4438
4439 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
Nikola Smiljanic67860242014-09-26 00:28:20 +00004440 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
4441 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004442 return NNS;
4443 }
4444
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004445 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004446}
4447
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004448const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004449 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004450 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004451 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4452 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4453 return AT;
4454 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004455
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004456 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004457 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004458 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004459
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004460 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004461 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4462 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004463
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004464 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4465 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004466 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004467
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004468 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004469 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004470
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004471 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004472 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004473 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004474 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004475
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004476 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4477 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004478 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004479
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004480 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4481 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4482 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004483 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004484 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4485 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4486 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004487 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004488
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004489 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004490 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4491 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004492 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004493 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004494 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004495 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004496 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004497
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004498 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004499 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004500 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004501 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004502 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004503 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004504}
4505
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004506QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004507 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4508 return getDecayedType(T);
4509 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004510}
4511
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004512QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004513 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4514 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4515 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4516}
4517
David Majnemerd09a51c2015-03-03 01:50:05 +00004518QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
4519 // C++ [except.throw]p3:
4520 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
4521 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
4522 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
4523 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
4524 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
4525 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4526 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4527 T = getDecayedType(T);
4528 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4529}
4530
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004531/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4532/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4533/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4534/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4535///
4536/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004537QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004538 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4539 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4540 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4541 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4542 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4543 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004544
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004545 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004546
4547 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004548 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004549}
4550
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004551QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4552 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004553}
4554
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004555QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4556 Qualifiers qs;
4557 while (true) {
4558 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004559 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004560 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004561
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004562 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004563 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004564 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004565
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004566 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004567}
4568
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004569/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004570uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004571ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4572 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4573 do {
4574 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004575 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4576 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004577 } while (CA);
4578 return ElementCount;
4579}
4580
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004581/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4582/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004583static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004584 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004585 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004586
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004587 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4588 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004589 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004590 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004591 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4592 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4593 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004594 }
4595}
4596
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004597/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4598/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004599/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4600/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004601QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4602 QualType Domain) const {
4603 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4604 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4605 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004606 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004607 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4608 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4609 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4610 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004611 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004612
4613 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4614 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004615 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004616 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4617 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4618 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004619 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004620 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004621}
4622
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004623/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4624/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4625/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004626/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004627int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004628 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4629 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004630
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004631 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004632 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004633 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004634 return 1;
4635 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004636}
4637
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004638/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4639/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4640/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004641unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004642 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004643
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004644 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004645 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004646 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004647 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004648 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4649 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4650 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4651 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004652 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004653 case BuiltinType::Short:
4654 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004655 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004656 case BuiltinType::Int:
4657 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004658 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004659 case BuiltinType::Long:
4660 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004661 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004662 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4663 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004664 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004665 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4666 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4667 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004668 }
4669}
4670
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004671/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4672/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4673///
4674/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4675/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004676QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004677 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4678 return QualType();
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004679
4680 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
4681 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
4682 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
4683
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004684 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004685 if (!Field)
4686 return QualType();
4687
4688 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4689
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004690 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004691 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004692 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
4693 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
4694 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
4695 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
4696 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
4697 // promotion applies to it.
4698 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
4699 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
4700 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
4701 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
4702 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
4703 //
4704 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
4705 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004706 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4707 return IntTy;
4708
4709 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4710 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4711
4712 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004713 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
4714 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
4715 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
4716 // into their semantics in some cases).
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004717 return QualType();
4718}
4719
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004720/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4721/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4722/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004723QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004724 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4725 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004726 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4727 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004728
4729 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4730 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4731 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4732 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4733 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4734 // unsigned long long int [...]
4735 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4736 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4737 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4738 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4739 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4740 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4741 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4742 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4743 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4744 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4745 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4746 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4747 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4748 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4749 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4750 }
4751 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4752 }
4753 }
4754
4755 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004756 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4757 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004758 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4759 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004760 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4761 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4762}
4763
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004764/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4765/// type and returns its ownership.
4766Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4767 while (!T.isNull()) {
4768 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4769 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4770 if (T->isArrayType())
4771 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4772 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4773 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4774 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004775 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004776 else
4777 break;
4778 }
4779
4780 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4781}
4782
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004783static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4784 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4785 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4786 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4787 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004788 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004789}
4790
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004791/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004792/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004793/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004794int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004795 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4796 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004797
4798 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4799 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4800 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4801 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4802 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4803
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004804 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004805
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004806 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4807 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004808
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004809 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4810 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004811
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004812 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4813 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4814 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4815 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004816
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004817 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4818 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4819 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4820 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4821 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004822
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004823 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4824 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004825 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004826 return -1;
4827 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004828
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004829 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4830 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4831 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004832
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004833 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4834 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004835 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004836 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004837}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004838
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004839// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004840QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004841 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004842 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString");
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004843 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004844
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004845 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004846
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004847 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004848 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004849 // int flags;
4850 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004851 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004852 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004853 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004854 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4855
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004856 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004857 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004858 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004859 SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004860 SourceLocation(), nullptr,
4861 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4862 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004863 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004864 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004865 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004866 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004867 }
4868
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004869 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004870 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004871
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004872 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004873}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004874
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004875QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4876 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004877 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004878 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4879 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4880 }
4881 return ObjCSuperType;
4882}
4883
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004884void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004885 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004886 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4887 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4888}
4889
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004890QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004891 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4892 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4893
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004894 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004895 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004896 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4897 RD->startDefinition();
4898
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004899 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4900 UnsignedLongTy,
4901 UnsignedLongTy,
4902 };
4903
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004904 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004905 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004906 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004907 };
4908
4909 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004910 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4911 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004912 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4913 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004914 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004915 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004916 }
4917
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004918 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004919
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004920 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004921
4922 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4923}
4924
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004925QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004926 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4927 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4928
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004929 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004930 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004931 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4932 RD->startDefinition();
4933
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004934 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4935 UnsignedLongTy,
4936 UnsignedLongTy,
4937 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4938 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4939 };
4940
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004941 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004942 "reserved",
4943 "Size",
4944 "CopyFuncPtr",
4945 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4946 };
4947
4948 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004949 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4950 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004951 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4952 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004953 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004954 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004955 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004956 }
4957
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004958 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004959
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004960 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004961 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4962}
4963
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004964/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4965/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4966/// in buildByrefHelpers.
4967bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4968 const VarDecl *D) {
4969 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4970 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4971 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4972
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004973 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00004974 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004975
4976 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4977
4978 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4979
4980 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4981 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004982 switch (lifetime) {
4983 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4984
4985 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4986 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4987 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4988 return false;
4989
4990 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4991 // byref routines.
4992 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4993 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4994 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4995 return true;
4996 }
4997 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4998 }
4999 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
5000 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005001}
5002
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005003bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
5004 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
5005 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
5006
5007 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
5008 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
5009 return false;
5010
5011 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00005012 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005013 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
5014 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005015 } else if ((LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime())) {
5016 // Honor the ARC qualifiers.
5017 } else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
5018 // The MRR rule.
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005019 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005020 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005021 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005022 }
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005023 return true;
5024}
5025
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005026TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
5027 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005028 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
5029 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005030 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
5031}
5032
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005033// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
5034// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00005035static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005036 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00005037 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
5038 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005039
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005040 return false;
5041}
5042
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005043/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005044/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005045CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005046 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
5047 return CharUnits::Zero();
5048
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005049 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005050
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005051 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00005052 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005053 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005054 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
5055 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005056 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005057 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005058}
5059
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005060bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00005061 return getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
5062 VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
David Majnemerfac52432015-10-19 23:22:49 +00005063 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5064 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005065}
5066
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005067static inline
5068std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
5069 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005070}
5071
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005072/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005073/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005074std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
5075 std::string S;
5076
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005077 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
5078 QualType BlockTy =
5079 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5080 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005081 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005082 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
5083 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
5084 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005085 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005086 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005087 // Compute size of all parameters.
5088 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5089 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5090 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005091 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5092 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00005093 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
5094 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005095 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00005096 if (sz.isZero())
5097 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005098 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005099 ParmOffset += sz;
5100 }
5101 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005102 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005103 // Block pointer and offset.
5104 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005105
5106 // Argument types.
5107 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00005108 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005109 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5110 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5111 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5112 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5113 // elements.
5114 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5115 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5116 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5117 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005118 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005119 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
5120 S, true /*Extended*/);
5121 else
5122 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005123 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005124 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005125 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005126
5127 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005128}
5129
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005130bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005131 std::string& S) {
5132 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005133 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005134 CharUnits ParmOffset;
5135 // Compute size of all parameters.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005136 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
5137 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005138 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005139 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005140 continue;
5141
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005142 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005143 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005144 ParmOffset += sz;
5145 }
5146 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5147 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
5148
5149 // Argument types.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005150 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005151 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5152 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5153 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5154 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5155 // elements.
5156 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5157 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5158 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5159 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5160 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5161 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5162 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5163 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005164
5165 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005166}
5167
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005168/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5169/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5170/// block object types.
5171void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5172 QualType T, std::string& S,
5173 bool Extended) const {
5174 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5175 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5176 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005177 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005178 true /*OutermostType*/,
5179 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
5180 false /*StructField*/,
5181 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
5182 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
5183}
5184
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005185/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005186/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005187bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005188 std::string& S,
5189 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005190 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005191 // Encode return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005192 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5193 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005194 // Compute size of all parameters.
5195 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5196 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5197 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005198 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005199 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
5200 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005201 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005202 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005203 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00005204 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005205 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005206 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005207 continue;
5208
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005209 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5210 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005211 ParmOffset += sz;
5212 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005213 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005214 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005215 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005216
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005217 // Argument types.
5218 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005219 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005220 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005221 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005222 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00005223 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005224 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5225 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5226 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00005227 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005228 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5229 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5230 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005231 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5232 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005233 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005234 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005235 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005236
5237 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005238}
5239
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005240ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
5241ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
5242 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5243 const Decl *Container) const {
5244 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005245 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005246 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
5247 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00005248 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
5249 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5250 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005251 } else {
5252 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
5253 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
5254 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5255 return PID;
5256 }
5257 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005258}
5259
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005260/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005261/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005262/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
5263/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005264/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
5265/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
5266/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
5267/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
5268/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005269/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
5270/// @code
5271/// enum PropertyAttributes {
5272/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
5273/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5274/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5275/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
5276/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
5277/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
5278/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00005279/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005280/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5281/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5282/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5283/// };
5284/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005285void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005286 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005287 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005288 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5289 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005290 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005291
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005292 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5293 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5294 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5295 Dynamic = true;
5296 else
5297 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005298 }
5299
5300 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5301 S = "T";
5302
5303 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005304 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5305 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005306 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005307
5308 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5309 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005310 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5311 S += ",C";
5312 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5313 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00005314 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5315 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005316 } else {
5317 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5318 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5319 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005320 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005321 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005322 }
5323 }
5324
5325 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5326 // are "dynamic by default".
5327 if (Dynamic)
5328 S += ",D";
5329
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005330 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5331 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005332
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005333 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5334 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005335 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005336 }
5337
5338 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5339 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005340 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005341 }
5342
5343 if (SynthesizePID) {
5344 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5345 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005346 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005347 }
5348
5349 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5350}
5351
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005352/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005353/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5354/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005355/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5356///
5357void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005358 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005359 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005360 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005361 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005362 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005363 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005364 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5365 }
5366 }
5367}
5368
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005369void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005370 const FieldDecl *Field,
5371 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005372 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5373 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5374 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5375 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005376 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005377 true /* outermost type */, false, false,
5378 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005379}
5380
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005381void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5382 std::string& S) const {
5383 // Encode result type.
5384 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5385 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5386 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5387 true /* outermost type */,
5388 true /* encoding property */);
5389}
5390
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005391static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5392 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5393 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005394 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5395 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5396 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5397 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005398 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005399 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005400 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005401 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5402 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005403 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005404 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5405 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5406 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5407 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5408 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005409 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5410 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005411 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5412 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005413 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005414 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5415 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5416 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5417 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005418 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005419 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5420
5421 case BuiltinType::Half:
5422 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5423 return ' ';
5424
5425 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5426 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5427 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5428 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5429
5430 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5431 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5432 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5433 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5434 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5435 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00005436 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth:
5437 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth:
5438 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA:
5439 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA:
5440 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth:
5441 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005442 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005443 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00005444 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
5445 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
5446 case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange:
5447 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005448 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005449 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5450#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5451#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5452 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5453#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5454 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005455 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005456 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005457}
5458
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005459static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5460 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5461
5462 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5463 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5464 return 'i';
5465
5466 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005467 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5468 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005469}
5470
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005471static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005472 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005473 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005474 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005475 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5476 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5477 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5478 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5479 //
5480 // struct
5481 // {
5482 // int integer;
5483 // int flags:2;
5484 // };
5485 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5486 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5487 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5488 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5489 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005490 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005491 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5492 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005493 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005494 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5495 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005496 else {
5497 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5498 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5499 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005500 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005501 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005502}
5503
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005504// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005505void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5506 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5507 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005508 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005509 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005510 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005511 bool StructField,
5512 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005513 bool EncodeClassNames,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005514 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5515 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005516 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5517 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5518 case Type::Builtin:
5519 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005520 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005521 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005522 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5523 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5524 else
5525 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005526 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005527
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005528 case Type::Complex: {
5529 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005530 S += 'j';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005531 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005532 return;
5533 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005534
5535 case Type::Atomic: {
5536 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5537 S += 'A';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005538 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005539 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005540 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005541
5542 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5543 case Type::Pointer:
5544 case Type::LValueReference:
5545 case Type::RValueReference: {
5546 QualType PointeeTy;
5547 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5548 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5549 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5550 S += ':';
5551 return;
5552 }
5553 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5554 } else {
5555 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5556 }
5557
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005558 bool isReadOnly = false;
5559 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5560 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5561 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005562 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005563 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005564 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5565 isReadOnly = true;
5566 S += 'r';
5567 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005568 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005569 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005570 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5571 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005572 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5573 isReadOnly = true;
5574 S += 'r';
5575 }
5576 }
5577 if (isReadOnly) {
5578 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5579 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5580 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005581 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005582 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005583 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005584
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005585 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5586 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5587 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005588 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005589 S += '*';
5590 return;
5591 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005592 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005593 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5594 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5595 S += '#';
5596 return;
5597 }
5598 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5599 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5600 S += '@';
5601 return;
5602 }
5603 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005604 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005605 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005606 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5607
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005608 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005609 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
5610 NotEncodedT);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005611 return;
5612 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005613
5614 case Type::ConstantArray:
5615 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5616 case Type::VariableArray: {
5617 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5618
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005619 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005620 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5621 S += '^';
5622
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005623 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005624 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5625 } else {
5626 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005627
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005628 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5629 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5630 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005631 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005632 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5633 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005634 S += '0';
5635 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005636
5637 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005638 false, ExpandStructures, FD,
5639 false, false, false, false, false, false,
5640 NotEncodedT);
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005641 S += ']';
5642 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005643 return;
5644 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005645
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005646 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5647 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005648 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005649 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005650
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005651 case Type::Record: {
5652 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005653 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005654 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5655 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5656 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005657 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5658 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5659 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005660 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5661 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005662 TemplateArgs.data(),
5663 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005664 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005665 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005666 } else {
5667 S += '?';
5668 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005669 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005670 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005671 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005672 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005673 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005674 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005675 if (FD) {
5676 S += '"';
5677 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5678 S += '"';
5679 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005680
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005681 // Special case bit-fields.
5682 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5683 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005684 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005685 } else {
5686 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5687 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5688 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5689 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5690 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005691 /*StructField*/true,
5692 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005693 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005694 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005695 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005696 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005697 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005698 return;
5699 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005700
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005701 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5702 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005703 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005704 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005705 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005706
5707 S += '<';
5708 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005709 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5710 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5711 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005712 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
5713 NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005714 // Block self
5715 S += "@?";
5716 // Block parameters
5717 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00005718 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5719 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5720 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5721 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005722 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
5723 false, NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005724 }
5725 S += '>';
5726 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005727 return;
5728 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005729
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00005730 case Type::ObjCObject: {
5731 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5732 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5733 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5734 S += "{objc_object=}";
5735 return;
5736 }
5737 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5738 S += "{objc_class=}";
5739 return;
5740 }
5741 }
5742
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005743 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5744 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005745 // @encode(class_name)
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00005746 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005747 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005748 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005749 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005750 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005751 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5752 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005753 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005754 if (Field->isBitField())
5755 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005756 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005757 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5758 false, false, false, false, false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005759 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5760 NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005761 }
5762 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005763 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005764 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005765
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005766 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5767 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005768 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5769 S += '@';
5770 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005771 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005772
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005773 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5774 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5775 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5776 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005777 S += '#';
5778 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005779 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005780
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005781 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005782 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005783 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5784 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005785 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005786 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5787 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005788 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005789 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005790 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005791 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005792 S += '>';
5793 }
5794 S += '"';
5795 }
5796 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005797 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005798
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005799 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5800 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005801 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5802 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005803 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005804 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005805 // {...};
5806 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005807 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005808 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005809 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5810 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5811 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5812 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5813 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5814 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005815 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005816 S += '}';
5817 return;
5818 }
5819 }
5820 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005821 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5822 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005823 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005824 false, false, false, false, false,
5825 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005826 return;
5827 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005828
5829 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005830 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5831 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005832 S += '"';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005833 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005834 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005835 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00005836 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005837 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005838 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005839 S += '"';
5840 }
5841 return;
5842 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005843
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005844 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005845 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5846 case Type::MemberPointer:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005847 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
5848 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005849 case Type::Vector:
5850 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005851 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
5852 { if (NotEncodedT)
5853 *NotEncodedT = T;
5854 return;
5855 }
5856
5857 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5858 // Just ignore it.
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005859 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005860 return;
5861
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005862#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5863#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5864#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5865 case Type::KIND:
5866#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5867 case Type::KIND:
5868#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5869 case Type::KIND:
5870#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5871 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005872 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005873 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005874}
5875
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005876void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5877 std::string &S,
5878 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005879 bool includeVBases,
5880 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005881 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5882 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5883 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5884 return;
5885
5886 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5887 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5888 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5889
5890 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00005891 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5892 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5893 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005894 if (base->isEmpty())
5895 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005896 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005897 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5898 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5899 }
5900 }
5901 }
5902
5903 unsigned i = 0;
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00005904 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005905 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5906 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00005907 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
5908 ++i;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005909 }
5910
5911 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00005912 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
5913 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005914 if (base->isEmpty())
5915 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005916 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00005917 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5918 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005919 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5920 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005921 }
5922 }
5923
5924 CharUnits size;
5925 if (CXXRec) {
5926 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5927 } else {
5928 size = layout.getSize();
5929 }
5930
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005931#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005932 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005933#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005934 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5935 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5936
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00005937 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5938 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005939 if (FD) {
5940 S += "\"_vptr$";
5941 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5942 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5943 S += recname;
5944 S += '"';
5945 }
5946 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005947#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005948 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005949#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005950 }
5951
5952 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5953 // Mark the end of the structure.
5954 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5955 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005956 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005957 }
5958
5959 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005960#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005961 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005962 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5963 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5964 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5965 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5966 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5967 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5968 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5969 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5970 // longer then though.
5971 CurOffs += padding;
5972 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005973#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005974
5975 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005976 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005977 break; // reached end of structure.
5978
5979 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5980 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5981 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5982 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5983 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005984 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
5985 NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005986 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005987#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005988 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005989#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005990 } else {
5991 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5992 if (FD) {
5993 S += '"';
5994 S += field->getNameAsString();
5995 S += '"';
5996 }
5997
5998 if (field->isBitField()) {
5999 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006000#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006001 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006002#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006003 } else {
6004 QualType qt = field->getType();
6005 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6006 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
6007 /*OutermostType*/false,
6008 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006009 /*StructField*/true,
6010 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006011#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006012 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006013#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006014 }
6015 }
6016 }
6017}
6018
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006019void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00006020 std::string& S) const {
6021 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
6022 S += 'n';
6023 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
6024 S += 'N';
6025 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
6026 S += 'o';
6027 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
6028 S += 'O';
6029 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
6030 S += 'R';
6031 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
6032 S += 'V';
6033}
6034
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006035TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
6036 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00006037 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, { }, { });
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006038 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006039 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006040 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006041 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00006042}
6043
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006044TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
6045 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006046 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
6047 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006048 }
6049 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00006050}
6051
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006052TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
6053 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00006054 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, { }, { });
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006055 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006056 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006057 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006058 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00006059}
6060
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006061ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
6062 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
6063 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
6064 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6065 SourceLocation(),
6066 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Douglas Gregor85f3f952015-07-07 03:57:15 +00006067 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006068 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006069 SourceLocation(), true);
6070 }
6071
6072 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
6073}
6074
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006075//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6076// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
6077//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6078
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006079static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6080 StringRef Name) {
6081 // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006082 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006083 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name);
6084}
6085
6086static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6087 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list");
6088}
6089
6090static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6091 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006092}
6093
6094static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6095 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006096 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6097 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006098}
6099
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006100static TypedefDecl *
6101CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006102 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006103 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006104 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6105 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6106 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6107 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6108 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006109 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006110 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006111 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006112 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006113 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006114 }
6115
6116 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6117
6118 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6119 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6120 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6121
6122 // void *__stack;
6123 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6124 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
6125
6126 // void *__gr_top;
6127 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6128 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
6129
6130 // void *__vr_top;
6131 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6132 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
6133
6134 // int __gr_offs;
6135 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
6136 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
6137
6138 // int __vr_offs;
6139 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
6140 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
6141
6142 // Create fields
6143 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6144 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6145 VaListTagDecl,
6146 SourceLocation(),
6147 SourceLocation(),
6148 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006149 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6150 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006151 /*Mutable=*/false,
6152 ICIS_NoInit);
6153 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6154 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6155 }
6156 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006157 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006158 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006159
6160 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006161 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006162}
6163
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006164static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6165 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6166 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6167
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006168 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006169 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6170
6171 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6172 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6173 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6174
6175 // unsigned char gpr;
6176 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6177 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
6178
6179 // unsigned char fpr;
6180 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6181 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
6182
6183 // unsigned short reserved;
6184 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
6185 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
6186
6187 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6188 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6189 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
6190
6191 // void* reg_save_area;
6192 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6193 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
6194
6195 // Create fields
6196 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6197 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
6198 SourceLocation(),
6199 SourceLocation(),
6200 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006201 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6202 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006203 /*Mutable=*/false,
6204 ICIS_NoInit);
6205 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6206 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6207 }
6208 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006209 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006210 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6211
6212 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006213 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6214 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6215
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006216 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6217 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6218
6219 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6220 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6221 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6222 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6223 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006224 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006225}
6226
6227static TypedefDecl *
6228CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006229 // struct __va_list_tag {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006230 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006231 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006232 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6233
6234 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6235 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6236 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6237
6238 // unsigned gp_offset;
6239 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6240 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
6241
6242 // unsigned fp_offset;
6243 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6244 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
6245
6246 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6247 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6248 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
6249
6250 // void* reg_save_area;
6251 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6252 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
6253
6254 // Create fields
6255 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6256 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6257 VaListTagDecl,
6258 SourceLocation(),
6259 SourceLocation(),
6260 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006261 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6262 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006263 /*Mutable=*/false,
6264 ICIS_NoInit);
6265 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6266 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6267 }
6268 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006269 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006270 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6271
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006272 // };
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006273
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006274 // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006275 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006276 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6277 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006278 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006279}
6280
6281static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6282 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
6283 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
6284 QualType IntArrayType
6285 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
6286 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006287 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006288}
6289
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006290static TypedefDecl *
6291CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006292 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006293 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006294 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6295 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6296 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6297 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6298 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6299 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6300 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006301 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006302 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006303 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006304 }
6305
6306 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6307
6308 // void * __ap;
6309 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6310 VaListDecl,
6311 SourceLocation(),
6312 SourceLocation(),
6313 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6314 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006315 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6316 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006317 /*Mutable=*/false,
6318 ICIS_NoInit);
6319 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6320 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6321
6322 // };
6323 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6324
6325 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006326 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6327 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006328}
6329
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006330static TypedefDecl *
6331CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006332 // struct __va_list_tag {
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006333 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006334 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006335 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6336
6337 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6338 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6339 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6340
6341 // long __gpr;
6342 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6343 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6344
6345 // long __fpr;
6346 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6347 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6348
6349 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6350 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6351 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6352
6353 // void *__reg_save_area;
6354 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6355 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6356
6357 // Create fields
6358 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6359 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6360 VaListTagDecl,
6361 SourceLocation(),
6362 SourceLocation(),
6363 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006364 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6365 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006366 /*Mutable=*/false,
6367 ICIS_NoInit);
6368 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6369 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6370 }
6371 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006372 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006373 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006374
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006375 // };
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006376
6377 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6378 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006379 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6380 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006381
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006382 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006383}
6384
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006385static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6386 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6387 switch (Kind) {
6388 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6389 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6390 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6391 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006392 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6393 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006394 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6395 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6396 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6397 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6398 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6399 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006400 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6401 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006402 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6403 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006404 }
6405
6406 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6407}
6408
6409TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006410 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006411 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006412 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6413 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006414
6415 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6416}
6417
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006418Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const {
6419 // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006420 // declaration.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006421 if (!VaListTagDecl)
6422 (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl();
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006423
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006424 return VaListTagDecl;
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006425}
6426
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006427TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const {
6428 if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl)
6429 BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this);
6430
6431 return BuiltinMSVaListDecl;
6432}
6433
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006434void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006435 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006436 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006437
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006438 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006439}
6440
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006441/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6442/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006443TemplateName
6444ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6445 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006446 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6447 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6448
6449 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6450 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6451 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6452
6453 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006454 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006455 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6456 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6457 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6458 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6459 *Storage++ = D;
6460 }
6461
6462 return TemplateName(OT);
6463}
6464
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006465/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6466/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006467TemplateName
6468ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6469 bool TemplateKeyword,
6470 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006471 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6472
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006473 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006474 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6475 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6476
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006477 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006478 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6479 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6480 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006481 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6482 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006483 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6484 }
6485
6486 return TemplateName(QTN);
6487}
6488
6489/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6490/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006491TemplateName
6492ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6493 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006494 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006495 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006496
6497 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6498 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6499
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006500 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006501 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6502 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6503
6504 if (QTN)
6505 return TemplateName(QTN);
6506
6507 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6508 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006509 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6510 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006511 } else {
6512 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006513 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6514 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006515 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6516 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6517 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6518 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006519 }
6520
6521 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6522 return TemplateName(QTN);
6523}
6524
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006525/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6526/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6527TemplateName
6528ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006529 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006530 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6531 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6532
6533 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6534 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006535
6536 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006537 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6538 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006539
6540 if (QTN)
6541 return TemplateName(QTN);
6542
6543 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6544 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006545 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6546 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006547 } else {
6548 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006549 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6550 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006551
6552 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6553 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6554 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6555 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006556 }
6557
6558 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6559 return TemplateName(QTN);
6560}
6561
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006562TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006563ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6564 TemplateName replacement) const {
6565 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6566 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006567
6568 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006569 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6570 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6571
6572 if (!subst) {
6573 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6574 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6575 }
6576
6577 return TemplateName(subst);
6578}
6579
6580TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006581ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6582 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6583 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6584 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6585 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006586
6587 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006588 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6589 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6590
6591 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006592 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006593 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6594 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6595 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6596 }
6597
6598 return TemplateName(Subst);
6599}
6600
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006601/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006602/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6603/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006604CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006605 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006606 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00006607 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6608 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006609 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6610 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6611 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6612 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6613 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6614 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6615 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6616 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6617 }
6618
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006619 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006620}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006621
6622//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6623// Type Predicates.
6624//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6625
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006626/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6627/// garbage collection attribute.
6628///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006629Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006630 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006631 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6632
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006633 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006634 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6635
6636 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6637 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6638 // as __strong.
6639 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6640 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6641 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6642 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6643 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6644 } else {
6645 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6646 // pointer.
6647#ifndef NDEBUG
6648 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6649 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6650 CT = AT->getElementType();
6651 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6652#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006653 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006654 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006655}
6656
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006657//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6658// Type Compatibility Testing
6659//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006660
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006661/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006662/// compatible.
6663static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6664 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006665 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006666 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006667 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006668}
6669
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006670bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6671 QualType SecondVec) {
6672 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6673 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6674
6675 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6676 return true;
6677
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006678 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6679 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006680 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6681 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006682 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006683 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006684 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6685 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6686 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6687 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006688 return true;
6689
6690 return false;
6691}
6692
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006693//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6694// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6695//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6696
6697/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6698/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006699bool
6700ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6701 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006702 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006703 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00006704 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6705 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006706 return true;
6707 return false;
6708}
6709
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006710/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6711/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006712bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6713 QualType rhs) {
6714 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6715 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6716 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6717
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006718 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006719 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006720 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006721 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6722 match = true;
6723 break;
6724 }
6725 }
6726 if (!match)
6727 return false;
6728 }
6729 return true;
6730}
6731
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006732/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6733/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6734bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6735 bool compare) {
6736 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006737 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006738 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6739 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006740 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006741 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6742 return true;
6743
6744 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006745 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006746
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006747 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006748
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006749 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006750 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006751 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6752 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006753 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006754 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6755 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6756 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006757 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006758 return false;
6759 }
6760 }
6761 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6762 return true;
6763 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006764 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006765 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006766 bool match = false;
6767
6768 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6769 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6770 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006771 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006772 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6773 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6774 match = true;
6775 break;
6776 }
6777 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006778 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006779 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6780 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006781 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006782 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6783 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6784 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006785 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006786 match = true;
6787 break;
6788 }
6789 }
6790 }
6791 if (!match)
6792 return false;
6793 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006794
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006795 return true;
6796 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006797
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006798 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6799 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6800
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006801 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006802 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006803 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006804 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006805 bool match = false;
6806
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006807 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006808 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6809 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006810 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6811 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006812 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006813 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6814 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6815 match = true;
6816 break;
6817 }
6818 }
6819 if (!match)
6820 return false;
6821 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006822
6823 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6824 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6825 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6826 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6827 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6828 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6829 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6830 // assume that it is mismatch.
6831 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6832 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006833 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006834 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006835 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006836 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6837 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6838 match = true;
6839 break;
6840 }
6841 }
6842 if (!match)
6843 return false;
6844 }
6845 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006846 return true;
6847 }
6848 return false;
6849}
6850
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006851/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006852/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6853/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6854///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006855bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6856 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006857 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6858 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6859
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006860 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006861 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6862 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006863 return true;
6864
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006865 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
6866 // __kindof types.
6867 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
6868 if (succeeded)
6869 return true;
6870
6871 if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
6872 return false;
6873
6874 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
6875 // we can assign the other way.
6876 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6877 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
6878 };
6879
6880 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
6881 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6882 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6883 false));
6884 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006885
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006886 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
6887 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6888 QualType(RHSOPT,0)));
6889 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006890
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006891 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006892 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
6893 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
6894 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006895
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006896 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006897}
6898
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006899/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006900/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006901/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6902/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6903/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6904bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6905 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006906 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6907 bool BlockReturnType) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006908
6909 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
6910 // __kindof types.
6911 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
6912 if (succeeded)
6913 return true;
6914
6915 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
6916 if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
6917 return false;
6918
6919 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
6920 // we can assign the other way.
6921 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6922 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6923 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6924 BlockReturnType);
6925 };
6926
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006927 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006928 return true;
6929
6930 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006931 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
6932 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006933 }
6934
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006935 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006936 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6937 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6938 false));
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006939
6940 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6941 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6942 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6943 if (LHS != RHS) {
6944 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006945 return finish(BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006946 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00006947 return finish(!BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006948 }
6949 else
6950 return true;
6951 }
6952 return false;
6953}
6954
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006955/// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
6956/// llvm::array_pod_sort.
6957static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
6958 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
6959 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
6960
6961}
6962
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006963/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006964/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
6965/// the given common base.
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006966/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6967/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6968static
6969void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006970 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006971 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6972 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006973 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006974
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006975 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6976 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6977 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6978 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006979
6980 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
6981 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
6982
6983 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
6984 for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) {
6985 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006986 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006987
6988 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
6989 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
6990
6991 // Add all of the protocls for the RHS.
6992 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
6993
6994 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
6995 for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) {
6996 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006997 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006998
6999 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
7000 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
7001
7002 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
7003 for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
7004 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
7005 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
7006 }
7007
7008 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
7009 // the protocols within the intersection.
7010 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
7011 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
7012
7013 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
7014 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
7015 IntersectionSet.erase(
7016 std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(),
7017 IntersectionSet.end(),
7018 [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
7019 return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0;
7020 }),
7021 IntersectionSet.end());
7022 }
7023
7024 // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
7025 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
7026 compareObjCProtocolsByName);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007027}
7028
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007029/// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
7030static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
7031 QualType rhs) {
7032 // Common case: two object pointers.
7033 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7034 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7035 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
7036 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
7037
7038 // Two block pointers.
7039 const BlockPointerType *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7040 const BlockPointerType *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7041 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
7042 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
7043
7044 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
7045 // acceptable.
7046 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
7047 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
7048 return true;
7049
7050 return false;
7051}
7052
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007053// Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007054static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
7055 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
7056 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007057 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
7058 bool stripKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007059 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
7060 return false;
7061
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007062 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007063 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007064 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7065 continue;
7066
7067 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
7068 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007069 if (!stripKindOf ||
7070 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
7071 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
7072 return false;
7073 }
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007074 break;
7075
7076 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
7077 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7078 return false;
7079 break;
7080
7081 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
7082 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
7083 return false;
7084 break;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007085 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007086 }
7087
7088 return true;
7089}
7090
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007091QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007092 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
7093 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007094 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
7095 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
7096 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
7097 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007098
7099 if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007100 return QualType();
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007101
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007102 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
7103 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
7104 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
7105 LHSAncestors;
7106 while (true) {
7107 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
7108 // path from the LHS to the root.
7109 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007110
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007111 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
7112 // Get the type arguments.
7113 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7114 bool anyChanges = false;
7115 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7116 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007117 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7118 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007119 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007120 return QualType();
7121 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7122 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7123 // arguments.
7124 LHSTypeArgs = { };
7125 anyChanges = true;
7126 }
7127
7128 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007129 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007130 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7131 Protocols);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007132 if (!Protocols.empty())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007133 anyChanges = true;
7134
7135 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
7136 if (anyChanges) {
7137 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007138 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
7139 LHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007140 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7141 }
7142
7143 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007144 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007145
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007146 // Find the superclass.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007147 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
7148 if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
7149 break;
7150
7151 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7152 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007153
7154 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
7155 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
7156 while (true) {
7157 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
7158 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
7159 LHS = KnownLHS->second;
7160
7161 // Get the type arguments.
7162 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7163 bool anyChanges = false;
7164 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7165 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007166 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7167 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007168 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007169 return QualType();
7170 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7171 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7172 // arguments.
7173 RHSTypeArgs = { };
7174 anyChanges = true;
7175 }
7176
7177 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
7178 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
7179 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7180 Protocols);
7181 if (!Protocols.empty())
7182 anyChanges = true;
7183
7184 if (anyChanges) {
7185 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007186 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
7187 RHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007188 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7189 }
7190
7191 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
7192 }
7193
7194 // Find the superclass of the RHS.
7195 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
7196 if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
7197 break;
7198
7199 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7200 }
7201
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007202 return QualType();
7203}
7204
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007205bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
7206 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
7207 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
7208 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
7209
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007210 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
7211 // the LHS.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007212 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
7213 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
7214 if (!IsSuperClass)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007215 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007216
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007217 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
7218 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
7219 // LHS).
7220 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007221 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
7222 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
7223 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
7224 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
7225 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
7226 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
7227 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
7228 // qualifiers.
7229 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007230 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007231 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
7232 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00007233 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007234
7235 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
7236 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
7237 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
7238 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
7239 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
7240 break;
7241 }
7242 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
7243 return false;
7244 }
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007245 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007246
7247 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
7248 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
7249 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
7250 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
7251 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
7252 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
7253 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7254
7255 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007256 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007257 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7258 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007259 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007260 return false;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007261 }
7262 }
7263
7264 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007265}
7266
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007267bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7268 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007269 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7270 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007271
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007272 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007273 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007274
7275 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
7276 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007277}
7278
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00007279bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
7280 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
7281 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7282 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
7283}
7284
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007285/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007286/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007287/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007288/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007289bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
7290 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007291 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007292 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
7293
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007294 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007295}
7296
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00007297bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00007298 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00007299}
7300
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007301bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7302 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
7303}
7304
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007305/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
7306/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
7307/// QualType()
7308QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
7309 bool OfBlockPointer,
7310 bool Unqualified) {
7311 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
7312 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
7313 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00007314 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
7315 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007316 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7317 if (!MT.isNull())
7318 return MT;
7319 }
7320 }
7321 }
7322
7323 return QualType();
7324}
7325
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007326/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
7327/// parameter types
7328QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7329 bool OfBlockPointer,
7330 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007331 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
7332 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
7333 // type is compatible with a union member
7334 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
7335 Unqualified);
7336 if (!lmerge.isNull())
7337 return lmerge;
7338
7339 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
7340 Unqualified);
7341 if (!rmerge.isNull())
7342 return rmerge;
7343
7344 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7345}
7346
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007347QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007348 bool OfBlockPointer,
7349 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007350 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
7351 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007352 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
7353 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007354 bool allLTypes = true;
7355 bool allRTypes = true;
7356
7357 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007358 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007359 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007360 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
7361 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007362 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
7363 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
7364 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007365 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007366 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007367 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007368 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007369 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007370 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007371
7372 if (Unqualified)
7373 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
7374
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007375 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
7376 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007377 if (Unqualified) {
7378 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7379 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7380 }
7381
7382 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007383 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007384 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007385 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007386
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00007387 // FIXME: double check this
7388 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7389 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7390 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00007391 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
7392 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007393
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007394 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007395 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007396 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007397
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007398 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00007399 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
7400 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007401 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
7402 return QualType();
7403
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007404 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
7405 return QualType();
7406
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007407 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
7408 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007409
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00007410 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7411 allLTypes = false;
7412 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7413 allRTypes = false;
7414
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007415 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007416
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007417 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007418 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
7419 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007420 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
7421 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007422 return QualType();
7423
7424 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
7425 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
7426 return QualType();
7427
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00007428 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
7429 return QualType();
7430
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007431 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
7432 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
7433 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007434
7435 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007436 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007437 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
7438 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7439 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7440 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
7441 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7442 if (paramType.isNull())
7443 return QualType();
7444
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007445 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007446 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
7447
7448 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007449 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007450 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7451 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007452 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007453
7454 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007455 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007456 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007457 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007458 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007459
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007460 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7461 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007462
7463 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7464 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007465 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007466 }
7467
7468 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7469 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7470
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007471 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007472 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007473 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007474 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7475 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7476 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7477 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7478 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7479 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007480 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
7481 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007482
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007483 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007484 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007485 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7486 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7487 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007488 return QualType();
7489 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007490
7491 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7492 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007493 return QualType();
7494 }
7495
7496 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7497 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007498
7499 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7500 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007501 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007502 }
7503
7504 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7505 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007506 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007507}
7508
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007509/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7510static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7511 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7512 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7513 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7514 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7515 // type.
7516 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7517 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7518 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7519 return other;
7520
7521 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7522 // integral type of the same size.
7523 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7524 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7525 return other;
7526
7527 return QualType();
7528}
7529
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007530QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007531 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007532 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007533 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7534 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7535 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007536 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7537 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007538 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7539 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007540
7541 if (Unqualified) {
7542 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7543 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7544 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007545
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007546 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7547 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7548
7549 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7550 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7551 return LHS;
7552
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007553 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007554 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7555 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007556 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7557 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7558 // mismatch.
7559 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007560 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7561 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007562 return QualType();
7563
7564 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7565 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7566 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7567 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7568 // qualified __strong.
7569 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7570 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7571 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7572
7573 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7574 return QualType();
7575
7576 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7577 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7578 }
7579 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7580 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7581 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007582 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007583 }
7584
7585 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007586
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007587 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7588 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007589
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007590 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7591 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7592 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7593 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007594
7595 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007596 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7597 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7598 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7599 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007600
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007601 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7602 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7603 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7604
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007605 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7606 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7607 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007608
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007609 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007610 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007611 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7612 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007613 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007614 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007615 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007616 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007617 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007618 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007619 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007620 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7621 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7622 return LHS;
7623 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7624 return RHS;
7625 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007626
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007627 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007628 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007629
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007630 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007631 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007632#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7633#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007634#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007635#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7636#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7637#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007638 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007639
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007640 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007641 case Type::LValueReference:
7642 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007643 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007644 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007645
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007646 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007647 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7648 case Type::VariableArray:
7649 case Type::FunctionProto:
7650 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007651 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007652
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007653 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007654 {
7655 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007656 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7657 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007658 if (Unqualified) {
7659 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7660 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7661 }
7662 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7663 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007664 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007665 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007666 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007667 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007668 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007669 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7670 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007671 case Type::BlockPointer:
7672 {
7673 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007674 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7675 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007676 if (Unqualified) {
7677 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7678 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7679 }
7680 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7681 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007682 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7683 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7684 return LHS;
7685 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7686 return RHS;
7687 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7688 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007689 case Type::Atomic:
7690 {
7691 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7692 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7693 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7694 if (Unqualified) {
7695 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7696 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7697 }
7698 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7699 Unqualified);
7700 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7701 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7702 return LHS;
7703 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7704 return RHS;
7705 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7706 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007707 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007708 {
7709 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7710 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7711 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7712 return QualType();
7713
7714 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7715 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007716 if (Unqualified) {
7717 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7718 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7719 }
7720
7721 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007722 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007723 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7724 return LHS;
7725 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7726 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007727 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7728 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7729 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7730 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007731 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7732 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007733 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7734 return LHS;
7735 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7736 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007737 if (LVAT) {
7738 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7739 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7740 // has to be different.
7741 return LHS;
7742 }
7743 if (RVAT) {
7744 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7745 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7746 // has to be different.
7747 return RHS;
7748 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007749 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7750 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007751 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7752 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007753 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007754 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007755 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007756 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007757 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007758 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007759 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007760 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007761 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007762 case Type::Complex:
7763 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7764 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007765 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007766 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007767 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7768 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007769 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007770 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007771 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7772 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007773 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7774 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007775 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7776 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7777 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007778 return LHS;
7779
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007780 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007781 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007782 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007783 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7784 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7785 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007786 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7787 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007788 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007789 return QualType();
7790 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007791 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7792 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007793 return LHS;
7794
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007795 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007796 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007797 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007798
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007799 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007800}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007801
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007802bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7803 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7804 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007805 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() !=
7806 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007807 return false;
7808 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7809 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7810 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7811 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00007812 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007813 for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) {
7814 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i])
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007815 return false;
7816 }
7817 return true;
7818}
7819
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00007820void ASTContext::ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl *CD) {
7821 ObjCLayouts[CD] = nullptr;
7822}
7823
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007824/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7825/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7826/// return types.
7827QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7828 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7829 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7830 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7831 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7832 return LHS;
7833 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7834 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7835 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007836 QualType OldReturnType =
7837 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007838 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007839 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007840 QualType ResReturnType =
7841 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7842 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7843 return QualType();
7844 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7845 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7846 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7847 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7848 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007849 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7850 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007851 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007852 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007853 return ResultType;
7854 }
7855 }
7856 return QualType();
7857 }
7858
7859 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7860 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7861 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7862 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7863 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7864 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7865 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7866 return QualType();
7867
7868 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7869 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7870 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7871 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7872 // qualified __strong.
7873 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7874 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7875 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7876
7877 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7878 return QualType();
7879
7880 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7881 return LHS;
7882 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7883 return RHS;
7884 return QualType();
7885 }
7886
7887 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7888 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7889 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7890 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7891 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7892 return LHS;
7893 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7894 return RHS;
7895 }
7896 return QualType();
7897}
7898
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007899//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007900// Integer Predicates
7901//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007902
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007903unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00007904 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007905 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007906 if (T->isBooleanType())
7907 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007908 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007909 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7910}
7911
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00007912QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00007913 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007914
7915 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7916 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7917 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007918 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007919
7920 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7921 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007922 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007923
7924 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7925 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007926 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7927 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7928 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7929 return UnsignedCharTy;
7930 case BuiltinType::Short:
7931 return UnsignedShortTy;
7932 case BuiltinType::Int:
7933 return UnsignedIntTy;
7934 case BuiltinType::Long:
7935 return UnsignedLongTy;
7936 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7937 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00007938 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7939 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007940 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007941 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007942 }
7943}
7944
Angel Garcia Gomez637d1e62015-10-20 13:23:58 +00007945ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00007946
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00007947void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7948 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007949
7950//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7951// Builtin Type Computation
7952//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7953
7954/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007955/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7956/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7957/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7958/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007959///
7960/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7961/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007962static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007963 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007964 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007965 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007966 // Modifiers.
7967 int HowLong = 0;
7968 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007969 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007970
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007971 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007972 bool Done = false;
7973 while (!Done) {
7974 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007975 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007976 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007977 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007978 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007979 case 'S':
7980 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7981 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7982 Signed = true;
7983 break;
7984 case 'U':
7985 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00007986 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007987 Unsigned = true;
7988 break;
7989 case 'L':
7990 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7991 ++HowLong;
7992 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00007993 case 'W':
7994 // This modifier represents int64 type.
7995 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
7996 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
7997 default:
7998 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
7999 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
8000 HowLong = 1;
8001 break;
8002 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
8003 HowLong = 2;
8004 break;
8005 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008006 }
8007 }
8008
8009 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008010
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008011 // Read the base type.
8012 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008013 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008014 case 'v':
8015 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8016 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
8017 Type = Context.VoidTy;
8018 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008019 case 'h':
8020 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008021 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008022 Type = Context.HalfTy;
8023 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008024 case 'f':
8025 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8026 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
8027 Type = Context.FloatTy;
8028 break;
8029 case 'd':
8030 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8031 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
8032 if (HowLong)
8033 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
8034 else
8035 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
8036 break;
8037 case 's':
8038 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
8039 if (Unsigned)
8040 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
8041 else
8042 Type = Context.ShortTy;
8043 break;
8044 case 'i':
8045 if (HowLong == 3)
8046 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
8047 else if (HowLong == 2)
8048 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
8049 else if (HowLong == 1)
8050 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
8051 else
8052 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
8053 break;
8054 case 'c':
8055 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
8056 if (Signed)
8057 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
8058 else if (Unsigned)
8059 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
8060 else
8061 Type = Context.CharTy;
8062 break;
8063 case 'b': // boolean
8064 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
8065 Type = Context.BoolTy;
8066 break;
8067 case 'z': // size_t.
8068 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
8069 Type = Context.getSizeType();
8070 break;
8071 case 'F':
8072 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
8073 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00008074 case 'G':
8075 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
8076 break;
8077 case 'H':
8078 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
8079 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00008080 case 'M':
8081 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
8082 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008083 case 'a':
8084 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8085 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
8086 break;
8087 case 'A':
8088 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
8089 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
8090 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
8091 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
8092 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
8093 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
8094 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
8095 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
8096 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8097 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008098 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008099 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008100 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008101 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008102 break;
8103 case 'V': {
8104 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008105 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8106 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008107 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008108
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008109 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
8110 RequiresICE, false);
8111 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008112
8113 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00008114 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008115 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008116 break;
8117 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00008118 case 'E': {
8119 char *End;
8120
8121 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8122 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
8123
8124 Str = End;
8125
8126 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8127 false);
8128 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
8129 break;
8130 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00008131 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008132 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8133 false);
8134 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00008135 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
8136 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00008137 }
8138 case 'Y' : {
8139 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
8140 break;
8141 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00008142 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00008143 Type = Context.getFILEType();
8144 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008145 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008146 return QualType();
8147 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008148 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00008149 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008150 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00008151 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008152 else
8153 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
8154
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008155 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008156 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008157 return QualType();
8158 }
8159 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00008160 case 'K':
8161 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
8162 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
8163
8164 if (Type.isNull()) {
8165 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
8166 return QualType();
8167 }
8168 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00008169 case 'p':
8170 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
8171 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00008172 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008173
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008174 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
8175 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008176 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00008177 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008178 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
8179 case '*':
8180 case '&': {
8181 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
8182 // qualified with an address space.
8183 char *End;
8184 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8185 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
8186 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
8187 Str = End;
8188 }
8189 if (c == '*')
8190 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
8191 else
8192 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
8193 break;
8194 }
8195 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
8196 case 'C':
8197 Type = Type.withConst();
8198 break;
8199 case 'D':
8200 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
8201 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00008202 case 'R':
8203 Type = Type.withRestrict();
8204 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008205 }
8206 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008207
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008208 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008209 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008210
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008211 return Type;
8212}
8213
8214/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008215QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008216 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008217 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Eric Christopher02d5d862015-08-06 01:01:12 +00008218 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008219
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008220 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008221
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008222 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008223 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008224 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
8225 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008226 if (Error != GE_None)
8227 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008228
8229 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
8230
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008231 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008232 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008233 if (Error != GE_None)
8234 return QualType();
8235
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008236 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
8237 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
8238 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
8239 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
8240
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008241 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
8242 if (Ty->isArrayType())
8243 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008244
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008245 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
8246 }
8247
David Majnemerba3e5ec2015-03-13 18:26:17 +00008248 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
8249 return QualType();
8250
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008251 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
8252 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
8253
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008254 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00008255 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
8256
8257 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
8258
8259 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
8260 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
8261 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00008262
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008263 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00008264 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
8265 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008266
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00008267 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008268}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00008269
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008270static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
8271 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008272 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008273 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008274
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008275 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8276 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
8277 case TSK_Undeclared:
8278 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
8279 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8280 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008281
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008282 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008283 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008284
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00008285 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
8286 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
8287 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
8288 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
8289 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
8290 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008291 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008292 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8293
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008294 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008295 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008296 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008297 }
8298
8299 if (!FD->isInlined())
8300 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00008301
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00008302 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
8303 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008304 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00008305 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008306 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
8307
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008308 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
8309 // externally visible.
8310 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
8311 return External;
8312
8313 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008314 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008315 }
8316
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008317 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
8318 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
8319 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
David Majnemer73768702015-03-20 00:02:27 +00008320 if (FD->isMSExternInline())
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008321 return GVA_StrongODR;
8322
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008323 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008324}
8325
Artem Belevich7b41f702015-09-23 17:44:53 +00008326static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008327 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
8328 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
8329 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
8330 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
8331 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Artem Belevich7b41f702015-09-23 17:44:53 +00008332 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() || D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008333 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
8334 return GVA_StrongODR;
8335 }
8336 return L;
8337}
8338
8339GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
Artem Belevich7b41f702015-09-23 17:44:53 +00008340 return adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD),
8341 FD);
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008342}
8343
8344static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
8345 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008346 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
8347 return GVA_Internal;
8348
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008349 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
8350 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
8351 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
8352 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
8353 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
8354
Richard Smith9e2341d2015-03-23 03:25:59 +00008355 // Let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the nearest
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008356 // enclosing function.
8357 if (LexicalContext)
8358 StaticLocalLinkage =
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008359 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008360
8361 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
8362 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
8363 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
8364 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
8365 : StaticLocalLinkage;
8366 }
8367
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008368 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
8369 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
8370 // cause link errors.
8371 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
8372 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8373
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00008374 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008375 case TSK_Undeclared:
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008376 return GVA_StrongExternal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008377
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008378 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00008379 return Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
8380 VD->isStaticDataMember()
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008381 ? GVA_StrongODR
8382 : GVA_StrongExternal;
8383
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008384 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008385 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008386
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008387 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
8388 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8389
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008390 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008391 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008392 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00008393
8394 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008395}
8396
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008397GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
Artem Belevich7b41f702015-09-23 17:44:53 +00008398 return adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD),
8399 VD);
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008400}
8401
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00008402bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008403 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
8404 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
8405 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00008406 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
8407 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
8408 return false;
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00008409 if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
8410 isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
8411 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00008412 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8413 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
8414 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
8415 return false;
Alexey Bataev97720002014-11-11 04:05:39 +00008416 } else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
8417 return true;
8418 else
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00008419 return false;
8420
8421 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
8422 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008423 return false;
8424
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008425 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
8426 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
8427 return false;
8428
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008429 // Aliases and used decls are required.
8430 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
8431 return true;
8432
8433 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8434 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00008435 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00008436 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008437
8438 // Constructors and destructors are required.
8439 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
8440 return true;
8441
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00008442 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
8443 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
8444 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
8445 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
8446 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
8447 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
8448 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
8449 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
8450 return true;
8451 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008452 }
8453 }
8454
8455 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
8456
8457 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
8458 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
8459 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008460 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
8461 Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008462 return false;
8463 return true;
8464 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00008465
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008466 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
8467 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
8468
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008469 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
8470 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008471 return false;
8472
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008473 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008474 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00008475 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
8476 L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008477 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008478
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008479 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
8480 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
8481 return true;
8482
8483 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00008484 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) &&
8485 !VD->evaluateValue())
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008486 return true;
8487
8488 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008489}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008490
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008491CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
8492 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008493 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008494 if (IsCXXMethod)
8495 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00008496
Alexander Kornienko21de0ae2015-01-20 11:20:41 +00008497 if (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) return CC_X86StdCall;
8498
8499 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008500}
8501
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008502bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00008503 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8504 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
8505}
8506
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00008507VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
8508 if (!VTContext.get()) {
8509 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
8510 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
8511 else
8512 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
8513 }
8514 return VTContext.get();
8515}
8516
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008517MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008518 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00008519 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008520 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
8521 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +00008522 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008523 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00008524 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +00008525 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +00008526 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008527 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008528 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008529 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008530 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008531 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008532}
8533
Angel Garcia Gomez637d1e62015-10-20 13:23:58 +00008534CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008535
8536size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00008537 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8538 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8539 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8540 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8541 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8542 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8543 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8544 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8545 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8546 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8547 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8548 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8549 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8550 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008551}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008552
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00008553/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8554/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8555/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8556/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8557QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8558 unsigned Signed) const {
8559 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8560 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8561 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8562 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8563 return QualTy;
8564}
8565
8566/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8567/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8568/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8569QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8570 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8571 switch (Ty) {
8572 case TargetInfo::Float:
8573 return FloatTy;
8574 case TargetInfo::Double:
8575 return DoubleTy;
8576 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8577 return LongDoubleTy;
8578 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8579 return QualType();
8580 }
8581
8582 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8583}
8584
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008585void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8586 if (Number > 1)
8587 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008588}
8589
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008590unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8591 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8592 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8593 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008594}
8595
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00008596void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8597 if (Number > 1)
8598 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8599}
8600
8601unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8602 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8603 StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8604 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8605}
8606
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008607MangleNumberingContext &
8608ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00008609 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8610 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8611 if (!MCtx)
8612 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8613 return *MCtx;
8614}
8615
8616MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8617 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008618}
8619
David Majnemere7a818f2015-03-06 18:53:55 +00008620const CXXConstructorDecl *
8621ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
8622 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8623 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
8624}
8625
8626void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
8627 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
8628 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8629 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
8630 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
8631}
8632
David Majnemerdfa6d202015-03-11 18:36:39 +00008633void ASTContext::addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8634 unsigned ParmIdx, Expr *DAE) {
8635 ABI->addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8636 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx, DAE);
8637}
8638
8639Expr *ASTContext::getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8640 unsigned ParmIdx) {
8641 return ABI->getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8642 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx);
8643}
8644
David Majnemer00350522015-08-31 18:48:39 +00008645void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
8646 TypedefNameDecl *DD) {
8647 return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
8648}
8649
8650TypedefNameDecl *
8651ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
8652 return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
8653}
8654
8655void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
8656 DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
8657 return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
8658}
8659
8660DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
8661 return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
8662}
8663
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008664void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8665 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8666}
8667
8668unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8669 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8670 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8671 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8672 return I->second;
8673}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008674
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008675APValue *
8676ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8677 bool MayCreate) {
8678 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8679 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00008680 if (MayCreate) {
8681 APValue *&MTVI = MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8682 if (!MTVI)
8683 MTVI = new (*this) APValue;
8684 return MTVI;
8685 }
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008686
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00008687 return MaterializedTemporaryValues.lookup(E);
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008688}
8689
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008690bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8691 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8692 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8693 return false;
8694
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00008695 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8696 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8697 return false;
8698
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008699 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8700 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8701 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8702 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8703 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8704 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8705 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8706}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008707
8708namespace {
8709
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008710ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(
8711 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers::mapped_type U) {
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00008712 if (const auto *D = U.dyn_cast<const Decl *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008713 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*D);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00008714 if (const auto *S = U.dyn_cast<const Stmt *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008715 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*S);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00008716 return *U.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008717}
8718
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008719/// Template specializations to abstract away from pointers and TypeLocs.
8720/// @{
8721template <typename T>
8722ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const T &Node) {
8723 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node);
8724}
8725template <>
8726ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const TypeLoc &Node) {
8727 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
8728}
8729template <>
8730ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode
8731createDynTypedNode(const NestedNameSpecifierLoc &Node) {
8732 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
8733}
8734/// @}
8735
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008736 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8737 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8738 ///
8739 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8740 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8741 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8742 ///
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00008743 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008744 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008745 public:
8746 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8747 ///
8748 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008749 static std::pair<ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *,
8750 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *>
8751 buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8752 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMapPointers,
8753 new ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008754 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008755 return std::make_pair(Visitor.Parents, Visitor.OtherParents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008756 }
8757
8758 private:
8759 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8760
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008761 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents,
8762 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents)
8763 : Parents(Parents), OtherParents(OtherParents) {}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008764
8765 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8766 return true;
8767 }
8768 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8769 return true;
8770 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008771
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008772 template <typename T, typename MapNodeTy, typename BaseTraverseFn,
8773 typename MapTy>
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008774 bool TraverseNode(T Node, MapNodeTy MapNode,
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008775 BaseTraverseFn BaseTraverse, MapTy *Parents) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008776 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008777 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008778 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00008779 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
8780 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
8781 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
8782 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
8783 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
8784 // new matches.
8785 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8786 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8787 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8788 // do not have pointer identity.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008789 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[MapNode];
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008790 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008791 if (const auto *D = ParentStack.back().get<Decl>())
8792 NodeOrVector = D;
8793 else if (const auto *S = ParentStack.back().get<Stmt>())
8794 NodeOrVector = S;
8795 else
8796 NodeOrVector =
8797 new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008798 } else {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008799 if (!NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
8800 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(
8801 1, getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(NodeOrVector));
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008802 if (auto *Node =
8803 NodeOrVector
8804 .template dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>())
8805 delete Node;
Benjamin Kramer422b3ff2015-10-23 13:24:18 +00008806 NodeOrVector = Vector;
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008807 }
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008808
8809 auto *Vector =
8810 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
8811 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
8812 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
8813 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
8814 // types.
8815 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
8816 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
8817 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
8818 if (!Found)
8819 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008820 }
8821 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008822 ParentStack.push_back(createDynTypedNode(Node));
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008823 bool Result = BaseTraverse();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008824 ParentStack.pop_back();
8825 return Result;
8826 }
8827
8828 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008829 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, DeclNode,
8830 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseDecl(DeclNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008831 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008832 }
8833
8834 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008835 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, StmtNode,
8836 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseStmt(StmtNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008837 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008838 }
8839
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008840 bool TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLoc TypeLocNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008841 return TraverseNode(
8842 TypeLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(TypeLocNode),
8843 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLocNode); },
8844 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008845 }
8846
8847 bool TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLocNode) {
8848 return TraverseNode(
8849 NNSLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(NNSLocNode),
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00008850 [&] {
8851 return VisitorBase::TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NNSLocNode);
8852 },
8853 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008854 }
8855
8856 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents;
8857 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008858 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8859
8860 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8861 };
8862
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00008863} // anonymous namespace
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008864
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008865template <typename NodeTy, typename MapTy>
8866static ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList getDynNodeFromMap(const NodeTy &Node,
8867 const MapTy &Map) {
8868 auto I = Map.find(Node);
8869 if (I == Map.end()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008870 return llvm::ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008871 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008872 if (auto *V = I->second.template dyn_cast<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008873 return llvm::makeArrayRef(*V);
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008874 }
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00008875 return getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(I->second);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008876}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008877
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00008878ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList
8879ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8880 if (!PointerParents) {
8881 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8882 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8883 auto Maps = ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl());
8884 PointerParents.reset(Maps.first);
8885 OtherParents.reset(Maps.second);
8886 }
8887 if (Node.getNodeKind().hasPointerIdentity())
8888 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node.getMemoizationData(), *PointerParents);
8889 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node, *OtherParents);
8890}
8891
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008892bool
8893ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8894 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8895 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8896 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8897 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8898 return false;
8899 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8900 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8901 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008902 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008903 return false;
8904
8905 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8906 return false;
8907
8908 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8909 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8910 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8911 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8912 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8913 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8914 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8915 return false;
8916 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8917 return false;
8918 }
8919 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8920
8921}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00008922
8923// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
8924// doesn't include ASTContext.h
8925template
8926clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8927 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
8928clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8929 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
8930 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);